WO1999026920A1 - Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii) - Google Patents

Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii) Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO1999026920A1
WO1999026920A1 PCT/US1998/025167 US9825167W WO9926920A1 WO 1999026920 A1 WO1999026920 A1 WO 1999026920A1 US 9825167 W US9825167 W US 9825167W WO 9926920 A1 WO9926920 A1 WO 9926920A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
carbon atoms
ring
substituted
atoms
alkyl
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US1998/025167
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Joseph Edward Semple
Marguerita S. Lim-Wilby
Terence K. Brunck
Original Assignee
Corvas International, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from US08/979,440 external-priority patent/US6204384B1/en
Priority claimed from US08/980,114 external-priority patent/US6011047A/en
Application filed by Corvas International, Inc. filed Critical Corvas International, Inc.
Priority to AU16056/99A priority Critical patent/AU1605699A/en
Publication of WO1999026920A1 publication Critical patent/WO1999026920A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C311/00Amides of sulfonic acids, i.e. compounds having singly-bound oxygen atoms of sulfo groups replaced by nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
    • C07C311/50Compounds containing any of the groups, X being a hetero atom, Y being any atom
    • C07C311/51Y being a hydrogen or a carbon atom
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C311/00Amides of sulfonic acids, i.e. compounds having singly-bound oxygen atoms of sulfo groups replaced by nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
    • C07C311/01Sulfonamides having sulfur atoms of sulfonamide groups bound to acyclic carbon atoms
    • C07C311/12Sulfonamides having sulfur atoms of sulfonamide groups bound to acyclic carbon atoms of an unsaturated carbon skeleton containing rings
    • C07C311/13Sulfonamides having sulfur atoms of sulfonamide groups bound to acyclic carbon atoms of an unsaturated carbon skeleton containing rings the carbon skeleton containing six-membered aromatic rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D211/00Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings
    • C07D211/04Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D211/06Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D211/08Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D211/18Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D211/34Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring carbon atoms with hydrocarbon radicals, substituted by carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07FACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
    • C07F5/00Compounds containing elements of Groups 3 or 13 of the Periodic System
    • C07F5/02Boron compounds
    • C07F5/025Boronic and borinic acid compounds

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to compounds which are potent and specific inhibitors of thrombin.
  • the present invention relates to novel peptide aldehydes, their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, and pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof which are useful as potent and specific inhibitors of blood coagulation in vitro and in vivo in mammals.
  • the invention relates to methods of using these inhibitors as therapeutic agents for disease states in mammals characterized by abnormal thrombosis .
  • Normal hemostasis is the result of a complex balance between the processes of clot formation (blood coagulation) and clot dissolution (fibrinolysis) .
  • Blood coagulation is the culmination of a series of amplified reactions in which several specific zymogens of serine proteases in plasma are activated by limited proteolysis. Nemerson, Y. and Nossel, H.L., Ann. Rey. Med. , 33; 479 (1982) . This series of reactions results in the formation of an insoluble fibrin matrix which is required for the stabilization of the primary hemostatic plug. The interaction and propagation of the activation reactions occurs through the extrinsic and intrinsic pathways of coagulation.
  • Factor Xa catalyzes the penultimate step in the blood coagulation cascade which is the formation of the serine protease thrombin. This step occurs following the assembly of the prothrombinase complex which is composed of factor Xa, the non-enzymatic co-factor Va and the substrate prothrombin assembled on the surface of adhered, activated platelets or systemically circulating membranous microparticles .
  • Proteolytic activation of zymogen factor X to its catalytically active form, factor Xa can occur by either the intrinsic or extrinsic coagulation pathways.
  • the intrinsic pathway is referred to as "intrinsic" because everything needed for clotting is in the blood. Saito, H., "Normal Hemostatic Mechanisms", Disorders of Hemostasis. pp. 27-29, Grune & Stratton, Inc. (0. D. Ratnoff, M.D. and C D. Forbes, M.D. edit. 1984) .
  • This pathway is comprised of the zymogen serine proteases, factors IX and XI, and the non- enzymatic co-factor, factor VIII.
  • the initiation of the intrinsic pathway results in the activation of factor XI to XIa.
  • Factor XIa catalyzes the activation of factor IX to factor IXa which in combination with the activated form of factor VIII on an appropriate phospholipid surface, results in the formation of the tenase complex. This complex also catalyzes the formation of the serine protease, factor Xa, from its zymogen, factor X which subsequently results in clot formation.
  • extrinsic The extrinsic pathway is referred to as "extrinsic" because the tissue factor which binds to and facilitates the activation of factor VII comes from outside the blood. Saito, ⁇ d,.
  • the major components of this pathway are the zymogen serine protease, factor VII, and the membrane bound protein, tissue factor. The latter serves as the requisite non- enzymatic co-factor for this enzyme.
  • the initiation of this pathway is thought to be an autocatalytic event resulting from the activation of zymogen factor VII by trace levels of activated factor VII (factor Vila), both of which are bound to newly exposed tissue factor on membrane surfaces at sites of vascular damage.
  • the factor Vila/tissue factor complex directly catalyzes the formation of the serine protease, factor Xa, from its zymogen, factor X. Exposure of blood to injured tissue initiates blood clotting by the extrinsic pathway.
  • thrombin is catalyzed by factor Xa following the assembly of the catalytic prothrombinase complex as reviewed by Mann, K. G. et. al., "Surface-Dependent Reactions of the Vitamin K-Dependent Enzyme Complexes", Blood. 76: 1-16 (1990) .
  • This complex is composed of factor Xa, the non-enzymatic co-factor Va and the substrate prothrombin all assembled on an appropriate phospholipid surface.
  • the requirement of a macromolecular complex for efficient catalysis results in the protection of factor Xa from natural anticoagulant mechanisms such as heparin-antithrombin III mediated inhibition.
  • Thrombin is the primary mediator of thrombus formation. Thrombin acts directly to cause formation of insoluble fibrin from circulating fibrinogen. In addition, thrombin activates the zymogen factor XIII to the active transglutaminase factor Xllla which acts to covalently stabilize the growing thrombus by crosslinking the fibrin strands. orand, . and Konishi, K., Arch. Bioche . Biophvs . , 105: 58 (1964). Beyond it ' s direct role in the formation and stabilization of fibrin rich clots, the enzyme has been reported to have profound bioregulatory effects on a number of cellular components within the vasculature and blood. Shuman, M.A., Ann. NY Acad. ⁇ Ci . , 40 : 349 ( 1986 ) .
  • thrombin is the most potent agonist of platelet activation, and it has been demonstrated to be the primary pathophysiologic-mediator of platelet-dependent arterial thrombus formation. Edit, J.F. et al., . Clin.
  • Thrombin-mediated platelet activation leads to ligand-induced inter-platelet aggregation principally due to the bivalent interactions between adhesive ligands such as fibrinogen and fibronectin with platelet integrin receptors such as glycoprotein lib/Ilia which assume their active conformation following thrombin activation. Berndt, M.C. and Phillips, D.R., Platelets in Biolo ⁇ v and Pathology, pp 43-74, Elsevier/North Holland Biomedical Press (Gordon, J.L. edit. 1981) .
  • Thrombin-activated platelets can also support further thrombin production through the assembly of new prothrombinase and tenase (factor IXa, factor VTIIa and factor X) catalytic complexes on the membrane surface of intact activated platelets and platelet-derived microparticles, following thrombin-mediated activation of the non-enzymatic cofactors V and VIII, respectively. Tans, G. et al., Blood. 77: 2641
  • thrombin has been shown to influence other aspects of he ostasis. These include its effect as an important physiological anticoagulant.
  • the anticoagulant effect of thrombin is expressed following binding of thrombin to the endothelial cell membrane glycoprotein, thrombomodulin. This is thought to result in an alteration of the substrate specificity of thrombin thereby allowing it to recognize and proteolytically activate circulating protein C to give activated protein C (aPC) .
  • aPC is a serine protease which selectively inactivates the non- enzymatic co-factors Va and Villa resulting in a down- regulation of thrombin formation by the prothrombinase. and tenase catalytic complexes, respectively.
  • Esmon, C ., Science. 235 : 1348 (1987) The activation of protein C by thrombin in the absence of thrombomodulin is poor.
  • Thrombin has also been shown to be a potent direct mitogen for a number of. cell types, including cells of mesenchymal origin such as vascular smooth muscle cells. Chen, L.B.
  • thrombin acts as a direct secretagogue inducing the release of a number of bioactive substances from vascular endothelial cells including tissue plasminogen activator. Levin, E.G. et al., Thro b . Haemost .. 56 : 115 (1986).
  • the enzyme can indirectly elaborate potent mitogenic activity on vascular smooth muscle cells by the release of several potent growth factors (e.g. platelet- derived growth factor and epidermal growth factor) from platelet a-granules following thrombin-induced activation. Ross, R., E. Engl. J. Msd. , 211: 408 (1986).
  • potent growth factors e.g. platelet- derived growth factor and epidermal growth factor
  • abnormal hemostasis With respect to the coronary arterial vasculature, abnormal thrombus formation due to the rupture of an established atherosclerotic plaque is the major cause of acute myocardial infarction and unstable angina. Moreover, treatment of an occlusive coronary thrombus by either thrombolytic therapy or percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty (PTCA) is often accompanied by an acute thrombotic reclosure of the affected vessel which requires immediate resolution.
  • PTCA percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty
  • venous vasculature With respect to the venous vasculature, a high percentage of patients undergoing major surgery in the lower extremities or the abdominal area suffer from thrombus formation in the venous vasculature which can result in reduced blood flow to the affected extremity and a predisposition to pulmonary embolism.
  • Disseminated intravascular coagulopathy commonly occurs within both vascular systems during septic shock, certain viral infections and cancer and is characterized by the rapid consumption of coagulation factors and systemic coagulation which results in the formation of life-threatening thrombi occurring throughout the vasculature leading to widespread organ failure.
  • arterial thrombosis is the result of a complex interaction between fibrin formation resulting from the blood coagulation cascade and cellular components, particularly platelets, which make up a large percentage of arterial thrombi.
  • Heparin the most widely used clinical anticoagulant administered i.v., has not been shown to be universally effective in the treatment or prevention of acute arterial thrombosis or rethrombosis . Prins, M.H. and Hirsh, J. , J_. Am. CQll- Cardiol .. ⁇ 2: 3A (1991).
  • the need for safe and effective therapeutic anticoagulants has in one aspect focused on the role of the serine protease thrombin in blood coagulation.
  • Most preferred natural substrates for thrombin are reported to contain an uncharged amino acid in the P3 recognition subsite.
  • the thrombin cleavage site on the Aa chain of fibrinogen which is the primary physiological substrate for thrombin, is reported to contain a glycine residue in this position while the cleavage site on the Bb chain contains a serine, as shown below: P4 P3 P2 PI PI
  • Peptidyl derivatives having an uncharged residue in the P3 position are said to bind to the active site of thrombin and thereby inhibit the conversion of fibrinogen to fibrin and cellular activation have been reported.
  • These derivatives have either an aldehyde, chloromethyl ketone or boronic acid functionality associated with the PI amino acid.
  • substrate-like peptidyl derivatives such as D-phenylalanyl- prolyl-argininal (D-Phe-Pro-Arg-al) , D-phenylalanyl-prolyl- arginine-chloromethyl ketone (P-PACK) and acetyl-D- phenylalanyl-prolyl-boroarginine (Ac- (D-Phe) -Pro-boroArg) have been reported to inhibit thrombin by directly binding to the active site of the enzyme. Bajusz, S., Symposia Biologica Hungarica. 23.: 277 (1984), Bajusz, S. et al, £. ⁇ ted. Chem. P
  • Peptidyl compounds which are said to be active site inhibitors of thrombin but which differ in structure from those containing a uncharged amino acid in the P3 recognition subsite have been reported.
  • Argatroban also called 2R, 4R-4-methyl-l- [N-2- (3-methyl-l,2, 3 , 4-tetrahydro-8-quinolinesulfonyl) -L- argininy]-2-piperdinecarboxylic acid
  • Argatroban has been reported to be a potent antithrombotic agent in several experimental models of acute arterial thrombosis. Jang, I.K. et al., in both Circulation. 81: 219 (1990) and ⁇ irc.. Baa., £7: 1552 (1990).
  • Peptidyl compounds which are said to be inhibitors of thrombin and whose mode of action is thought to be by binding to both the active site and another site on the enzyme have been reported.
  • Hirudin and certain peptidyl derivatives of hirudin have been reported to inhibit both conversion of fibrinogen to fibrin and platelet activation by binding to either both the active site and exo site, or the exo site only, of thrombin.
  • Hirudin is reported to be a 65 amino acid polypeptide originally isolated from leech salivary gland extracts. It is said to be one of the most potent inhibitors of thrombin known. Marki, W.E.
  • hirudin has been reported to also effectively inhibit smooth muscle proliferation and the associated restenosis following mechanical damage to a atherosclerotic rabbit femoral artery.
  • Sarembock I.J. et al., Circulation. 84: 232 (1991).
  • Hirugen has been reported to be a peptide derived from the anionic carboxy-terminus of hirudin. It is reported to bind only to the anion binding exo-site of thrombin and thereby inhibit the formation of fibrin but not the catalytic turnover of small synthetic substrates which have access to the unblocked active site of the enzyme.
  • Maraganore J.M. et al., J. Biol. Chem..
  • the hirugen-like sequence is said to be linked to this peptide through the C-terminal end of the peptide.
  • the hirulogs have been reported to be an effective antithrombotic agents in preventing both fibrin-rich and platelet-rich thrombosis. Maraganone, J.M. et al., Thromb. Haemostas .. 65: 651 at abstract 17 (1991).
  • Benzamidines have been reported to inhibit thrombin though non-selectively.
  • 4-amidinophenylpyruvic acid (APPA) has been reported to be a thrombin inhibitor with low toxicity and favourable pharmacokinetics .
  • this compound was reported to be non-selective, inhibiting trypsin, plasmin and kallikrein. Markwardt et al., Thromb. Res.. 1:243-52 (1972).
  • Other benzamidine-derived structures which have been reported to inhibit thrombin include the cylic amides of N a -substituted 4-amidinophenylalanine and 2- amino-5- (4-amidinophenyl) -1-valeric acid.
  • Certain phenylguanidines have been reported to inhibit thrombin.
  • Derivatives of 4-guanidinophenylalanine with inhibitory constants in the micromolar range have been reported to inhibit thrombin.
  • This class includes the N a - tosylated and dansylated 4-guanidino phenylalanine piperidides. Claeson et. al., Thromb. Haemostas . r 11:53 (1983).
  • Another compound, [ethyl p- (6-guanidinohexanoyloxy) benzoate] methane sulfonate (FOY) was reported to be a non- selective competitive inhibitor of thrombin. Ohno et al., Thromb . Res.. 11:579-588 (1980).
  • Novel compounds of the present invention include compounds of the formula (I) :
  • X is selected from the group consisting of -S(0) 2 - #
  • R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is NHR', OR ' , R' , or SR' ;
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of: (1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
  • cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R'/ (4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R ' ,
  • alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C ⁇ 2R'»
  • aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y 2 , and/or Y3,
  • heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
  • aralkyl of about 7 -to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
  • Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]_0-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 "to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms; (c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms; (d) R3 is selected from the group consisting of
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of
  • heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
  • heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
  • alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z ⁇ wherein Z$ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg_ -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR9, an ⁇ -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and which
  • alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
  • aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
  • heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from o ⁇ rgen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
  • R7 is selected from the group consisting of
  • Ri is not a camphor derivative or ' ⁇ —z heterocycle, (ii) -CF3,or -CF2H,
  • alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2 1O/ -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll,
  • the present invention is based on our finding that these novel compounds are active as selective inhibitors of thrombin in vivo and in vi tro. Furthermore, certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have been found to exhibit advantageous selectivity in that they are potent inhibitors of thrombin, but are much less active and much less potent in inhibiting plas in and trypsin. Certain compounds of the present invention may also have broader serine protease inhibitory activity.
  • heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having about 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder.of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino; and (b) TS is selected from the group consisting of (i) -CHO, (ii) -C(0)CF 3 , (iii) -C(0)CF 2 CF 3 , (iv) -C(0)-C(0)-NHR 13 , (v) -C(0)-C(0) 2 R 13 ,
  • R ⁇ 3 and R ⁇ 4 are independently selected from hydrogen lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur
  • R-j_5 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms and heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur.
  • TS is ( vii)
  • additionally -0R ⁇ 3 and -OR ] ⁇ may be taken together to be -0[C(Z 3 ) (Z 4 )]qO- wherein Z 3 , Z 4 and q are as defined in connection with formula (I) .
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (II) are also included.
  • the present invention is directed to pharmaceutical compositions comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the present invention is directed to methods of using the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of formula (I) for the prevention of or treating. of thrombosis in a mammal suspected of having a condition of abnormal thrombosis, which comprises administering to said mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention or pharmaceutical composition comprising such a compound.
  • alkenyl refers to unsaturated aliphatic groups having at least one double bond.
  • alkyl refers to saturated aliphatic groups including straight-chain, branched-chain and cyclic groups.
  • alkoxy and alkoxyl refer to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an alkyl group.
  • alkoxycarbonyl refers to -C(0)OR wherein R is alkyl.
  • alkenyl refers to an alkenyl group substituted with an aryl group.
  • aralkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with an aryl group. Suitable aralkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl, and the like, all of which may be optionally substituted.
  • aryl refers to aromatic groups which have at least one ring having a conjugated pi electron system and includes carbocyclic aryl, heterocyclic aryl and biaryl groups, all of which may be optionally substituted.
  • aryloxy refers to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an aryl group.
  • R-0- refers to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an aralkyl group.
  • amino acid refers to natural amino acids, unnatural amino acids, and amino acid analogs, all in their D and L stereoisomers if their structure allow such stereoisomeric. Natural amino acids include alanine (Ala), arginine (Arg) , asparagine (Asn) , aspartic acid (Asp) , cysteine (Cys) , glutamine (Gin) , glutamic acid (Glu) , glycine (Gly), histidine (His), isoleucine (lie), leucine (Leu), lysine (Lys) , methionine (Met) , phenylalanine (Phe) , proline (Pro) , serine (Ser) , threonine (Thr) , tryptophan (Trp) , tyrosine (Tyr) and valine (Val) .
  • Natural amino acids include alanine (Ala), arginine (Arg) , asparagine
  • Unnatural amino acids include, but are not limited to azetidinecarboxylic acid, 2- aminoadipic acid, 3-aminoadipic acid, beta-alanine, aminopropionic acid, 2-aminobutyric acid, 4-aminobutyric acid, 6-aminocaproic acid, 2-aminoheptanoic acid, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, 3-aminoisobutyric acid, 2-aminopimelic acid, 2,4-diaminoisobutyric acid, desmosine, 2 , 2 ' -diaminopimelic acid, 2, 3-diaminopropionic acid, N- ethylglycine, N-ethylasparagine, hydroxylysine, allo- hydroxylysine, 3-hydroxyproline, 4-hydroxyproline, isodesmosine, allo-isoleucine, N-methylglycine, N- methylisoleucine, N-methylvaline, norvaline, norleucine,
  • Amino acid analogs include the natural and unnatural amino acids which are chemically blocked, reversibly or irreversibly, or modified on their N- terminal amino group or their side-chain groups, as for example, methionine sulfoxide, methionine sulfone,
  • amino acid analog refers to an amino acid wherein either the C-terminal carboxy group, the N-terminal amino group or side-chain functional group has been chemically modified to another functional group.
  • aspartic acid- (beta-methyl ester) is an amino acid analog of aspartic acid
  • N-ethylglycine is an amino acid analog of glycine
  • alanine carboxamide is an amino acid analog of alanine.
  • amino acid residue refers to radicals having the structure: (1) -C(0)-R-NH-, wherein R typically is -
  • aryl refers to phenyl substituted by carbocyclic or heterocyclic aryl as defined herein, ortho, meta or para to the point of attachment of the phenyl ring.
  • Carbocyclic aryl refers to aromatic groups wherein the ring atoms on the aromatic ring are carbon atoms.
  • Carbocyclic aryl groups include monocyclic carbocyclic aryl groups and naphthyl groups, all of which may be optionally substituted.
  • Suitable carbocyclic aryl groups include phenyl and naphthyl.
  • Suitable substituted carbocyclic aryl groups include indene and phenyl substituted by one to two substituents such being advantageously lower alkyl, hydroxy, lower alkoxy, lower alkoxycarbonyl, halogen, trifluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, nitro, and cyano.
  • Substituted naphthyl refers to naphthyl, more preferably 1- or 2-naphthyl, substituted by Y ⁇ , Y 2 and/or Y 3 as defined in connection with formula (I) hereinabove.
  • Cycloalkenyl refers to a cyclic alkenyl group. Suitable cycloalkenyl groups include, for example, cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl .
  • Cycloalkyl refers to a cyclic alkyl group. Suitable cycloalkyl groups include, for example, cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, and cycloheptyl. “Cyclohexylmethyl” refers to a cyclohexyl group attached to CH2.
  • halogen refers to fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
  • Heteroaralkenyl refers to an alkenyl group substitued with a heteroaryl, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems.
  • the alkenyl group has from 2 to about 6 carbon of atoms.
  • Heteroaralkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heteroaryl, such as picolyl, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems.
  • the alkyl group has from 1 to about 6 carbon atoms.
  • Heteroaryl refers to aryl groups having from 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C.
  • Suitable heteroatoms include oxygen, nitrogen, S(0) , wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and suitable heterocyclic aryls include furanyl, thienyl, pyridyl, pyrrolyl, pyrimidyl, pyrazinyl, imidazolyl, and the like.
  • Heterocyclo refers to a reduced heterocyclic ring system comprised of carbon, nitrogen, oxygen and/or sulfur ⁇ atoms, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C.
  • Heterocycloalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heterocyclo group, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems.
  • the alkyl group has from 1 to about 6 carbon atoms .
  • the term “lower” referred to herein in connection with organic radicals or groups defines such radicals or groups with one and up to and including 5 carbon atoms, preferably up to and including 4 carbon atoms, and advantageously one or two carbon atoms.
  • Such radicals or groups may be straight chain or branched chain.
  • Perfluoroalkyl refers to an alkyl group which has every hydrogen replaced with fluorine.
  • Perfluoroaryl refers to an aryl group which has every hydrogen replaced with fluorine.
  • Perfluoroaryl alkyl refers an aralkyl group in which every hydrogen on the aryl moiety is replaced with fluorine.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salt” includes salts of the compounds of the present invention derived from the combination of such compounds and an organic or inorganic acid. In practice the use of the salt form amounts to use of the base form. The compounds of the present invention are useful in both free base and salt form, with both forms being considered as being within the scope of the present invention.
  • the term "Arg-al” refers to the residue of L-argininal which has the formula:
  • Arg-ol refers to the residue of L-argininol which has the formula:
  • N-alpha-t-butoxycarbonyl-N ⁇ -nitro-L-arginine refers to the compound which has the formula:
  • Boc refers to t-buto3qrcarbonyl .
  • BzlS02 refers to benzylsulfonyl .
  • Cbz or w CBz” refers to benzyloxycarbonyl.
  • DCA dichloroacetic acid
  • DCC refers to N,N' -dicyclohexylcarbodiimide.
  • DMF N, N-dimethylformamide
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • DMAP 4-N,N-dimethylaminopyridine
  • EDC l-ethyl-3- (3-dimethylamino- propyl) carbodiimide hydrochloride salt.
  • Et 3 N refers to triethylamine.
  • HBTU refers to 2- (lH-benzotriazol-1-yl) -1, 1, 3 , 3- tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate .
  • HC1 hydrochloric acid
  • HOAc acetic acid
  • HPLC refers to high pressure liquid chromatography.
  • HOBt refers to 1-hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate.
  • i-BuOCOCl refers to isobutylchloroformate.
  • LiAlH4 refers to lithium aluminum hydride.
  • LiAlH2 (OEt)2 refers to lithium aluminum dihydride diethoxide.
  • Me refers to methyl
  • NMM refers to N-methylmorpholine .
  • PhB(0H) 2 refers to phenylboronic acid.
  • THF refers to tetrahydrofuran.
  • TLC refers to thin layer chromatography
  • Figure 1 provides a synthetic scheme for compound 11, which is further detailed in Examples 1 to 11.
  • the steps are defined as follows:
  • (2) from 6-amino-m-cresol : 1. phthalic anhydride, acetic acid, reflux to give a 95% yield of (1), N- (2-hydroxy-4- methylphenyDphthalimide) ; and 2. allyl bromide, K 2 C0 3 , acetonitrile, reflux to give 97% yield of (2) .
  • N,N-dimethylaniline, 185 * C about two hours, to give a 95% yield of (3) .
  • (5) from (3): 1.
  • Figure 2 provides a synthetic scheme for compound 19, which is further detailed in Examples 12 to 14.
  • the steps are defined as follows.
  • Figure 3 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of an intermediate used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) .
  • "i” through “vi” are defined as: i) thionyl chloride, methanol; ii) di-tert-butyl dicarbonate, pH 7-8; iii) hydrogen gas, platinum oxide in ethanol, water and acetic acid; iv) bis- benzyloxycarbonyl S-methylisothiourea, base, tetrahydrofuran; v) calcium chloride, sodium borohydride in tetrahydrofuran and ethanol; vi) HCl (anhydrous) .
  • "*" indicates the position of an asymmetric carbon atom.
  • Figures 4 and 5 depict preferred reaction schemes for synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) .
  • "i” through “iii” are defined as: i) HOBt, EDC, dimethylaminopyridine, triethyla ine; ii) hydrogen gas, 10% palladium on charcoal and iii) dimethylsulfoxide, toluene, dichloroacetic acid and EDC.
  • Figure 6 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of an intermediate used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) .
  • Figure 7 depicts a preferred reaction scheme for synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) .
  • "i” through “iii” are defined as: (i) EDC, hydroxybenzotriazole, 4-methyl-morpholine in DMF; (ii) HF/anisole (9:1), aqueous acetic acid; and (iii) methanol, 1% HF (aqueous) , formalin.
  • Figure 8 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) which incorporates an arginine chloromethylketone moiety at PI.
  • "i” through “iii” are defined as: (i) EDC, HOBt, NMM, CH 3 CN, room temperature; (iia) i-BuOCOCl, NMM, DMF at -20°C; (iib) add 45 DMF, Et 3 N, allow temperature to increase from -20° to room temperature; and (iii) HF, anisole.
  • Figure 9 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) which incorporates an argimine ketoamide moiety at PI.
  • "i” through “iii” are defined as: (i) EDC, HOBt, NMM, CH 3 CN, room temperature; (ii) H 2 , palladium on carbon, EtOH, H 2 0, HOAc to give intermediate 50; and (iii) EDC, DMSO, DCAA, toluene, temperature is allowed to increase from 0° to room temperature.
  • Figure 10 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) having a boronic acid moiety at PI.
  • Figure 11 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) having a C ⁇ to C 4 perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone moiety at PI.
  • Figure 12 depicts the reaction scheme for preparation of intermediate 69 which is used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) .
  • “i” through “vi” are defined as: i) thionyl chloride, methanol; ii) di-tert- butyl carbonate, pH 7-8; iii) hydrogen gas, platinum oxide in ethanol, water and acetic acid; iv) bis-benzyloxycarbonyl 5- methylisQthiourea, base, tetrahydrofuran; v) calcium chloride, sodium borohydride in tetrahydrofurin and ethanol; vi) HCl (anhydrous) .
  • "*" indicates the position of an assymetric carbon atom.
  • Novel compounds of the present invention include compounds of the Formula (I) :
  • X is selected from the group consisting of -S (0) 2 - ,
  • R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is NHR' , OR' , R' , or SR' ;
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms
  • cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Cl to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
  • heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and. which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R'.
  • aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, respectively,
  • heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and
  • heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
  • heteroaralkenyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2. and/or Y 3 ,
  • Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)] g 0-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z 3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms; (c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms;
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of
  • Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is
  • Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -ORs, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR8 and -S(0)pR8, wherein Rs is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms., and p is 0, 1 or 2, (v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
  • cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms
  • heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms are heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
  • heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of (i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, ⁇ S(0)nRl « wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor .
  • Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms including 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and p is 0, 1 or 2;
  • aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
  • R7 is selected from the group consisting of
  • alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10 * -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll,
  • alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll,
  • heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -S ⁇ 2Rl0 ⁇ r -CONRioRll, and
  • Preferred X groups include a direct link, -SO2-, and -NH-S(0)2 ⁇ .
  • An especially preferred X group is -SO2-.
  • Preferred Ri groups include alkyl, aralkyl, and aryl groups.
  • Preferred aryl groups include substituted or unsubstituted phenyl and naphthyl, 2, 3-methylenedioxyphenyl, and 3, 4-methylenedioxyphenyl.
  • Preferred substitutions include, methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, and -OCF3. Meta and ortho ring substitutions are preferred.
  • Meta and ortho di-substitutions on the ring are also preferred.
  • Particularly preferred Ri groups include aralkyl groups. Especially preferred Ri groups include substituted or unsubstituted benzyl and naphthylalkyl groups. Cyclohexyl and cyclohexylmethyl are also especially preferred Ri groups.
  • a particularly preferred R2 group is hydrogen.
  • Preferred R 3 groups include
  • Preferred R4 groups include: (i) hydrogen,
  • heteroaryl having 1 to about 4 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms are heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R4 groups also include methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, R-sec-butyl, S-sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, R-2-pentyl, S-2-pentyl, 3-pentyl, S-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, R-2- (3-methyl) -butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, R-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-hexyl, S-2-hexyl, R-2-hexyl, R-3-hexyl, S-3-hexyl, S-3
  • Preferred R6 groups include: (i) hydrogen,
  • alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of 1 to about 9 carbon atoms,
  • aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y 3 ,
  • heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and having the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
  • heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and having the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
  • R ⁇ groups when R4 and R5 are independently hydrogen or methyl, are selected from the group consisting of aralkyl of about 8 to about 13 carbon atoms, -O-Ri, -NH-R ⁇ _, and -S(0) p R ⁇ wherein Ri is preferably aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms.
  • Preferred aryl components of the aralkyl groups include unsubstituted and substituted phenyl or naphthyl groups.
  • Preferred substitutions on the aryl ring include methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, alkoxycarbonyl, methylenedioxy and amidocarbonyl .
  • Phenylethyl, phenylpropyl , cyclohexylethyl and cyclohexylpropyl are especially preferred R6 groups .
  • Especially preferred R7 groups include hydrogen, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl. Hydrogen and methyl are especially preferred R7 groups.
  • Preferred R7 groups also include those selected from the group consisting of: (i) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -S02Rl0 ⁇ r -CONRioRjLl,
  • aryl and heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10, -SO2R1O or -CONRioRll/ and .
  • R5 and Rg are independently selected to be hydrogen or methyl
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, R-sec- butyl, S-sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, R-2-pentyl, S-2- pentyl, 3-
  • a very preferred aspect is directed to such compounds where Rl is substituted or unsubstituted benzyl.
  • Particulary preferred compounds according to this invention include N- [2-hydroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyl]-L-argininal (Example 11) and N-[2- methoxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6-methylphenylacetyl] -L- argininal (Example 14) .
  • the present invention is directed to compounds having inhibitory activity toward proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class.
  • Crystal structures of serine protease inhibitors in complex with their cognate enzymes have been determined and are available from the Brookhaven National Laboratory Protein Data Bank.
  • the three-dimensional crystal structures of proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class are highly conserved within the class.
  • the most potent inhibitors in the class make specific hydrogen bonds with structurally conserved backbone atoms of amino acid 216 of the protease (using the standard chymotrypsin numbering system) . In most inhibitors, these hydrogen bonds are formed by atoms of peptide amide bonds or sulfonamide bonds.
  • this aspect of the invention is directed to compounds of formula (II) :
  • R12 is selected from the group consisting of
  • heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having about 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino;
  • TS is selected from the group consisting of (i) -CHO, (ii) -C(0)CF 3 ,
  • R 13 and R 14 are independently selected from hydrogen lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur, and R-L5 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms and heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur.
  • TS is (vii)
  • additionally -0R;L 3 and -OR ⁇ 4 may be taken together to be -0[C(Z 3 ) (Z 4 )]qO- wherein Z 3 , Z 4 and q are as defined in connection with formula (I) .
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (II) are also included.
  • inhibitors of elastase will have a small alkyl group, such as methyl, for R.._.
  • Inhibitors of chymotrypsin preferably will have an aralkyl group, such as benzyl, for R12 according to formula (II) .
  • Serine protease inhibitors that have a basic amino acid in the primary specificity site, such as inhibitors of trypsin, thrombin, factor Xa, factor Vila, will have an amino, amidino, or guanidino substituted alkyl, aryl, or aralkyl group for R12 •
  • the present invention includes within its scope salts of the compounds of formulas I and II.
  • These salts include salts of the compounds of the present invention derived from the combination of such compounds and an organic or inorganic acid.
  • the use of the salt form may amount to use of the (free) base form.
  • the compounds of the present invention are useful in both free base and salt form, with both forms being considered as being within the scope of the present invention.
  • These salts include acid addition salts, for example, salts of hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, acetic acid, benzene sulfonic acid and other suitable acid addition salts including maleate, fumarate and citrate salts .
  • Figures 1 and 2 depict synthetic schemes for two preferred compounds according to this invention.
  • Figure 1 outlines a sequence of reactions for the preparation of a preferred species of the present invention.
  • Commercially available 6-amino-m-cresol is reacted with phthalic anhydride, optionally in the presence of an inert solvent like acetic acid, toluene, or xylene, at about 100-150°C to afford the phthalimide intermediate 1.
  • Reaction of 1 with allyl bromide in the presence of a suitable base such as anhydrous potassium carbonate in an inert solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at a temperature in the range from about room temperature to about 110°C provides the allyl ether derivative intermediate 2.
  • a suitable base such as anhydrous potassium carbonate
  • an inert solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile
  • Reaction of phenol derivative 3 with benzyl bromide in an inert solvent such as N, N- dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at about room temperature to about 110°C provides the benzyl ether derivative 4.
  • Cleavage of the phthalimido moiety of 4 is achieved selectively utilizing hydrazine in an alcoholic solvent such as ethanol at a temperature from about 20 to 80°C and affords the aniline derivative 5.
  • a suitable sulfonyl chloride such as benzylsulfonyl chloride in an inert solvent such as N, N-dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile
  • Compound 8 is coupled to N9-nitro-L-argininal ethyl cyclol using 1-hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate, 1- ethyl-3- ( 3 -dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide hydrochloride salt , and then N, N-diisopropylamine to give 9 .
  • the N ⁇ -nitro group of 9 is removed by treatment with hydrogen gas and palladium on carbon in ethanol, water, and acetic acid at about 20 to 60 psi . This reaction produces acetate acid sal 10 .
  • the ethyl cyclol group of 10 is hydrolyzed by treatment with a suitable acid catalyst such as dilute hydrochloric acid, sulfuric acid, methanesulfonic acid, perchloric acid or hexaf luorophoshoric acid followed by HPLC purification with 0 . 1% trif luoroacetic acid in acetonitrile and water to produce the product 11.
  • a suitable acid catalyst such as dilute hydrochloric acid, sulfuric acid, methanesulfonic acid, perchloric acid or hexaf luorophoshoric acid followed by HPLC purification with 0 . 1% trif luoroacetic acid in acetonitrile and water to produce the product 11.
  • the reaction scheme of Figure 2 depicts the preparation of another very preferred compound. It differs from the synthetic scheme of Figure 1 in that intermediate 3 is first reacted with methyl iodide in the presence of a suitable base such as anhydrous potassium carbonate in an inert solvent such as N, N- dimethyl formamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at a temperature of about room temperature to about 110°C , to provide the methyl ether derivative 12 .
  • Intermediate 12 is processed through an analogous set of reactions to those outlined in Figure 1 to produce the target argininal derivative 19.
  • the preferred means of chemically coupling include formation of a peptide bond using conventional coupling reagents known in the art . See Bodanszky, N. , Peptide Chemistry, pp . 55-73 , Springer-Verlag, New York (1988) and references cited therein .
  • the chemical coupling may be either by means of one-step or two-step coupling. In one-step coupling, the two coupling partners are coupled directly.
  • Preferred coupling reagents for one-step coupling include DCC with HOBt, EDC with HOBt,. BOP, HBTU or TBTU.
  • an activated ester or anhydride of the C-terminal carboxy group of one coupling partner is formed prior to its coupling to the other coupling partner.
  • compounds of the present invention containing alkenyl or aryl moieties substituted with halogen, cyano, nitro, or -S-Zi it is preferred to avoid the use of hydrogen gas with palladium on carbon for cleaving the N9-nitro protecting group on the arginine s de chain. Instead, it is preferred to use boron tris (trifluoroacetate) , B(OCOCF3)3, to cleave the N ⁇ -nitro of the arginine group.
  • This reagent may be prepared by the reaction of BBr3 and CF3COOH in dichloromethane at 0°C.
  • the reagent is also commercially available.
  • the N ⁇ -nitro compound is treated with boron tris (trifluoroacetate) in trifluoroacetic acid at 0°C.
  • boron tris trifluoroacetate
  • Another preferred reagent for selective nitro group cleavage is titanium trichloride.
  • This reagent is commercially available.
  • the N ⁇ -nitro compound is treated with titanium trichloride in aqueous methanol containing an ammonium acetate buffer followed by exposure of the reaction mixture to air or dimethyl sulfoxide. See, e. g. , Freidinger, R.M. , Hirschmann, R. , and Veber, D.F., J. Pro. Chem.. 43, 4800 (1978).
  • Another preferred method for synthesizing these compounds having an L-argininal moiety is to use the di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl protecting group for the L-argininal moiety for groups incompatible with hydrogenation with palladium on carbon.
  • alpha-N-benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega' -di-N-t-butoxycarbonylarginine is dissolved in acetonitrile and treated with hydroxybenzotriazole and 1- ethyl-3-(3-dimethylamino-propyl)carbodiimide HCl salt to form alpha-N-benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega ' -di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl-L-arginine lactam.
  • the lactam is reduced by treatment with LiAlH4 in THF at -70°C to provide alpha-N- benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega '-di-N-t-butoxycarbonyl-L- argininal.
  • This aldehyde is protected as the diethyl acetal by treatment with ethanol and HCl.
  • the N-benzyloxycarbonyl protecting group is removed by treatment with hydrogen gas and palladium on carbon to give omega, omega' -di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl-L-argininal diethyl acetal, HCl salt.
  • This, protected L-argininal moiety can then be coupled to a desired carboxylic acid by treatment with N-hydro ⁇ benzotriazole and l-ethyl-3- (3-dimethylamino-propyl) carbodiimide HCl salt.
  • the diethyl acetal and the di-Boc protecting groups are removed by treatment with hexafluorophosphoric acid in acetonitrile at 0°C.
  • the reaction mixture is quenched by addition of 2.5 M aqueous sodium acetate until pH 4 is reached.
  • the mixture is filtered through a 2 micron filter.
  • FIG. 3 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 25 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) according to reaction schemes depicted in Figures 4 and 5. Examples 15 to 19 describe preparation of 25 in further detail.
  • Figures 4 and 5 depict reaction schemes for the preparation of certain compounds of formula (I) wherein R is a 3-piperidinyl-(N-guanidino) group.
  • Preparation of compound 28 is described in further detail in Examples 20 to 22.
  • Compound 31 is prepared using the appropriate reagents according to procedures similar to those described in Examples 20 to 22.
  • Figure 6 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of intermediate 41 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) according to the reaction scheme depicted in Figure 7.
  • Examples 24 to 30 describe the preparation of 41 in further detail.
  • Figure 7 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of a compound of formula (I) wherein R is 3-amidinophenyl.
  • Figure 12 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 69 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) .
  • Intermediate 69 is prepared by procedures similar to those described in Examples 15 to 19 and using the appropriate starting materials.
  • 69 may be coupled to intermediates such as 8 and 16 according to reaction schemes analogous to those depicted in Figures 4 and 5.
  • Figure 8 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-arginine chloromethylketone moiety.
  • Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known arginine chloromethylketone precursor 45 (Kettner, C. and Shaw, E., Biochemistry, 17: 4778 (1978); Kettner, C. and Shaw, E., Biochim. Biophys . Acta, 569: 31 (1979)) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate and NMM at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 46.
  • Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile or DMF.
  • Double deprotection of intermediate 46 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at a temperature in the range of about -78°C to about room temperature gives the desired product 47.
  • Figure 9 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-ketoargininamide moiety.
  • Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known hydroxyargininamide precursor 48 (see, e.g. commonly assigned U.S. Patent Nos. 5,371,072 and 5,597,804) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate, and NMM at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 49.
  • Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile or DMF.
  • intermediate 50 Deprotection of intermediate 49 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at about -78°C to about room temperature, or by catalytic hydrogenation using a suitable catalyst such as Pd/C or Pd(OH) 2 /C in a solvent composed of ethanol, water and/or acetic acid gives the intermediate 50. Finally, oxidation of intermediate 50 under the standard Moffatt conditions with EDC, DMSO and dichloroacetic acid in a suitable solvent such as toluene at about -10°C to room temperature produces the desired product
  • Figure 10 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-boronic acid moiety.
  • Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known protected boroarginine ester precursor 52 See, e. g. , Wityak, J. et. al., J. Ore. Chem.. 60: 3717 (1995) and references cited therein) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate, NMM and then in situ added Et 3 N at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 53.
  • Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile, dichloromethane, chloroform, DMF, or mixtures thereof.
  • Reaction of intermediate 53 with sodium azide in a suitable inert solvent such as DMF, N, N-dimethylacetamide, DMSO or l-methyl-2- pyrrolidinone at about room temperature to about 100°C affords the azide 54.
  • Catalytic hydrogenation of intermediate azide 54 in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol preferably in the presence of hydrogen chloride gives the intermediate amine salt 55.
  • Figure 11 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-Cl to C4 perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone moiety.
  • Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known perfluoroargininol precursor 58 see, e. g. , Schacht,
  • Reaction of 60 with a suitable optionally protected guanylating reagent such as bis-Cbz-S-methyl isothiourea in an inert solvent such as DMF or THF in the presence of a base such as triethylamine provides the protected intermediate 61.
  • Swern oxidation of 61 with a mixture of oxalyl chloride, DMSO, triethylamine in dichloromethane at about -78°C to room temperature gives the ketone intermediate 62.
  • deprotection of 62 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at about -78°C to room temperature produces the desired perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone 63.
  • Figure 12 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 69 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) .
  • Intermediate 69 may be coupled to intermediates such as 8 and 16 according to reaction schemes analogous to those depicted in Figures 4 and 5.
  • the compounds of the present invention are screened for their ability to inhibit thrombin, plasmin, tissue plasminogen activator (t-PA) , activated protein C (aPC) , chymotrypsin, and trypsin as set forth below. Certain of the preferred compounds are distinguished by their ability to inhibit thrombin, while not substantially inhibiting plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin.
  • the term "not substantially inhibiting" means that the IC50 (or Kj.) for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and/or trypsin for a given compound is greater than or equal to its IC50 (or Ki, respectively) for thrombin.
  • not specifically inhibiting means the IC 50 or K for the target enzyme is less than or equal to the IC 50 or K A for non-target enzymes contacted with the inhibitor.
  • the compounds of the present invention are dissolved in buffer to give solutions containing concentrations such that assay concentrations range from 0 to 100 micromolar.
  • a chromogenic synthetic substrate is added to a solution containing test compound and the enzyme of interest and the residual catalytic activity of that enzyme is determined spectrophometrically.
  • the IC5 Q of a compound of the present invention is determined from the rate of substrate turnover caused by the specific enzyme being measured.
  • IC50 is the concentration of test compound which gives 50% inhibition of the rate of substrate turnover.
  • the Ki of a compound of the present invention is determined from the rate of substrate turnover caused by the specific enzyme being measured at various enzyme concentrations. Examples A, B and C provide an exemplars of in vitro assays used to select the compounds of the present invention.
  • Certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have a Ki of about 0.001 to about 200 nM in the thrombin assay.
  • Especially preferred compounds have a K of about 0.001 to about 50 nM.
  • the more especially preferred compounds have a Ki of about 0.001 to about 10 nM.
  • Certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have a IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is at least 10 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin.
  • Especially preferred compounds have an IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is about 20 to about 100,000 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin. More especially preferred compounds have an IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is about 100 to about 1,000,000 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin.
  • a compound of the present invention has an IC50 with respect to plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, or trypsin which is greater than the highest concentration of compound tested, the highest concentration of compound tested is considered to be the reported IC50.
  • the present invention encompasses pharmaceutical compositions prepared for storage or administration which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the "therapeutically effective amount" of a compound of the present invention will depend on the route of administration, the type of mammal being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific mammal under consideration. These factors and their relationship to determining this amount are well known to skilled practitioners in the medical arts. This amount and the method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which, as noted, those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
  • the "therapeutically effective amount" of the compound of the present invention can range broadly depending upon the desired affects and the therapeutic indication. Typically, dosages will be between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers” for therapeutic use are well known in the pharmaceutical art, and are described, for example, in Remington' s Pharmeceutical Sciences . Mack Publishing Co. (A.R. Gennaro edit. 1985) .
  • sterile saline and phosphate-buffered saline at physiological pH may be used.
  • Preservatives, stabilizers, dyes and even flavoring agents may be provided in the pharmaceutical composition.
  • sodium benzoate, sorbic acid and esters of p-hydroxybenzoic acid may be added as preservatives . Id. at 1449.
  • antioxidants and suspending agents may be used. Id.
  • compositions of the present invention may be formulated and used as tablets, capsules or elixirs for oral administration; suppositories for rectal administration; sterile solutions and suspensions for injectable administration; and the like.
  • the dose and method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
  • injectable pharmaceutcial compositions can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions.
  • Suitable excipients are, for example, water, saline, dextrose, mannitol, lactose, lecithin, albumin, sodium glutamate, cysteine hydrochloride, or the like.
  • the injectable pharmaceutical compositions may contain minor amounts of nontoxic auxilliary substances, such as wetting agents, pH buffering agents, and the like.
  • absorption enhancing preparations e.g., liposomes may be utilized.
  • Certain compounds of the present invention when made and selected as disclosed are useful as potent inhibitors of thrombin in vitro and in vivo. As such, these compounds are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents to prevent the clotting of blood and as in vivo pharmaceutical agents to prevent thrombosis in mammals suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis.
  • the compounds of the present invention are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents for inhibiting clotting in blood drawing tubes .
  • the use of stoppered test tubes having a vaccum therein as a means to draw blood obtained by venipuncture into the tube is well known in the medical arts . See, e . g. , Kasten, B.L., "Specimen Collection", Laboratory Test Handbook.
  • Such vacuum tubes may be free of clot-inhibiting additives, in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian serum from the blood. They may alternatively contain clot-inhibiting additives (such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts), in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian plasma from the blood.
  • clot-inhibiting additives such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts
  • the compounds of the present invention are potent inhibitors of blood clotting enzymes, such as factor Xa or thrombin, and as such, can be incorporated into blood collection tubes to prevent clotting of the mammalian blood drawn into them.
  • the compounds of the present invention are used alone, in combination of other compounds of the present invention, or in combination with other known inhibitors of clotting, in the blood collection tubes .
  • the amount to be added to such tubes is that amount sufficient to inhibit the formation of a clot when mammalian blood is drawn into the tube.
  • the addition of the compounds to such tubes may be accomplished by methods well known in the art, such as by introduction of a liquid composition thereof, as a solid co ⁇ position thereof, or liquid composition which is lyophilized to a solid.
  • the compounds of the present invention are added to blood collection tubes in such amounts that, when combined with 2 to 10 mL of mammalian blood, the concentration of such compounds will be sufficient to inhibit clot formation. Typically, the required concentration will be about 1 to 10,000 nM, with 10 to 1000 nM being preferred.
  • Certain of the compounds of the present invention are useful as a pharmaceutical agent for preventing thrombosis in a mammal suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis .
  • Conditions characterized by abnormal thrombosis are well known in the medical arts and include those involving the arterial and venous vasculature of mammals.
  • abnormal thrombosis thrombus formation
  • PTCA percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty
  • abnormal thrombosis characterizes the condition observed in patients undergoing major surgery in the lower extremities or the abdominal area who often suffer from thrombus formation in the venous vasculature resulting in reduced blood flow to the affected extremity and a predisposition to pulmonary embolism.
  • Abnormal thrombosis further characterizes disseminated intravascular coagulopathy which commonly occurs within both vascular systems during septic shock, certain viral infections and cancer, a condition wherein there is rapid consumption of coagulation factors and systemic coagulation which results in the formation of life- threatening thrombi occurring throughout the microvasculature leading to widespread organ failure.
  • the present invention includes methods for preventing a condition in a mammal suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis, comprising administering to said mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or a pharmaceutical co ⁇ position of the present invention.
  • the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention are administered in vivo, ordinarily in a mammal, preferably in a human. In employing them in vivo, the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions can be administered to a mammal in a variety of ways, including orally, parenterally, intravenously, subcutaneously, intramuscularly, colonically, rectally, nasally or intraperitoneally, employing a variety of dosage forms .
  • Administration is preferably parenteral, such as intravenous on a daily basis.
  • administration is preferably oral, such as by. tablets, capsules or elixers taken on a daily basis.
  • the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention are administered alone or in combination with one another, or in combination with other therapeutic or in vivo diagnostic agents.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention will vary depending upon the age, weight and mammalian species treated, the particular compounds employed, the particular mode of administration and the desired affects and the therapeutic indication.
  • administration of the compounds or pharmaceutical composition of the present invention is commenced at lower dosage levels, with dosage levels being increased until the desired effect of preventing in vivo thrombosis is achieved which would define a therapeutically effective amount.
  • such doses are between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight.
  • Certain compounds of the present invention have utility as inhibitors of proteases within the trypsin/chymotrypsin class of enzymes.
  • Members of that class include, but are not limited to, elastase, chymotrypsin, and the serine proteases trypsin, thrombin, factor Xa, and factor Vila.
  • the inhibitors within the present invention directed at serine proteases acting within the coagulation cascade e. g. inhibitors of thrombin, factor Xa and factor Vila, such have in vi tro and in vivo utilities as provided hereinabove for thrombin inhibitors .
  • Elastase has been implicated in a variety of conditions, including pulmonary hypertension (Rabinovitch, M. , Acta Paediatr. Jpn 37:657-666 (1995)), idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis, rheumatoid arthritis, adult respiratory distress syndrome, cystic fibrosis, and other inflammatory diseases and conditions (Doring, G., Am. J. Respir. Crit. Care Med. 150:S114-S117 (1994)). Inhibition of elastase was shown to prevent or retard progression of pulmonary hypertension (Rabinovitch) .
  • inhibitors of the present invention directed toward elastase are useful as pharmaceutical compositions for the inhibition of elastase in conditions where elastase activity is associated with a pathological condition.
  • pancreatitis Elevated levels of chymotrypsin and trypsin are associated with the pathological effects resulting from pancreatitis (see US 5,534,498). Animal studies of chemically- induced pancreatitis suggest that the disorder is rooted in the inability of pancreatic acinar cells to excrete digestive proenzymes, resulting in activation of trypsinogen to trypsin by lysosomal hydrolases within the cell. The amount of trypsin produced exceeds protective levels of protease inhibitor normally available.
  • pancreatitis which is characterized by damage to the pancreas and surrounding tissues from autodigestion of the cells by the various digestive enzymes.
  • These activated digestive enzymes also cause edema, interstitial hemorrhage, vascular damage, coagulation necrosis, fat necrosis and parenchymal cell necrosis.
  • Inhibitors of the present invention directed toward either trypsin or chymotrypsin, or.ther members of the trypsin/chymotrypsin family that contribute to the deleterious effects of pancreatitis, are useful for the prevention and treatment of pancreatitis in mammals.
  • inhibitors of the present invention also find utility in vitro.
  • Inhibitors of enzymes within the coagulation cascade are useful inhibitors of blood coagulation in vitro, as described hereinabove.
  • Inhibitors of other enzymes within the trypsin/chymotrypsin family, including trypsin, chymotrypsin, and elastase are' useful reagents in in vi tro assays designed to measure the activity of such enzymes .
  • the activity of the enzyme in the sample is determined in the presence and absence of the specific inhibitor (which may be labeled using a radioactive or other detectable label) .
  • Lower activity measured in the presence of inhibitor as compared to in the absence of inhibitor demonstrates inhibition of the enzyme and, thus, its presence in the sample.
  • the level of activity of an enzyme present in a sample is determined by adding inhibitor to the sample in a range of titrating doses, and calculating activity of the enzyme at each escalating dose of inhibitor.
  • the concentration of inhibitor that completely inhibits the enzyme in the assay along with knowledge of the assay parameters and characteristic of enzyme inhibition, allows one to calculate the activity of the enzyme in the sample.
  • Chymotrypsin inhibitors of the present invention are useful in such assays to evaluate the level of active chymotrypsin in such a sample, according to protocols such as those outlined hereinabove.
  • An additional use of the inhibitors of the present invention is their use to quench enzymatic reactions effected by the target enzyme.
  • an inhibitor of trypsin or chymoptrypsin is added in inhibit the target enzume and, thus, control or prevent digestion by that enzyme.
  • Certain compounds of the present invention can also be useful inhibitors of elastase, and are therefore useful pharmaceutical agents for the control of inflammation.
  • Examples 1 to 11 describe preparation of compound 11 of Figure 1.
  • Examples 20 to 22 describe preparation of compound 28 of Figure 4.
  • Examples 24 to 30 describe preparation of compound 41 of Figure 6.
  • Example 5 To a solution of 5 (7.54 g, 0.0298 mole; see Example 5) and 4-methylmorpholine (9.04 g, 0.0894 mole, 9.83 mL) in 300 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile at 0°C under N2 was added ⁇ - toluene-sulfonyl chloride (11.36 g, 0.0596 mole) in one portion. The solution was stirred at 0°C for 1 hour and allowed to warm to and stir at ambient temperature for 19 hours. The solution was filtered and evaporated.
  • Example 6 (10.71 g, 0.0263 mole; see Example 6) dissolved in 260 mL of methanol at -78°C until a pale blue color persisted. After 3 minutes, a stream of dry 2 was bubbled through the solution to discharge excess ozone. Dimethyl sulfide (3.27 g, 0.0526 mole, 3.86 mL) was added, the solution was stirred at -78°C for 5 minutes, and was allowed to warm to and then stir at ambient temperature for 14 hours .
  • Dimethyl sulfide (3.27 g, 0.0526 mole, 3.86 mL) was added, the solution was stirred at -78°C for 5 minutes, and was allowed to warm to and then stir at ambient temperature for 14 hours .
  • the filtrate was purified by reverse phase HPLC on a 50 X 300 mm C18 column using a 0 to 28% gradient of acetonitrile/water (containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) over one hour to afford 0.66 g (63% yield) of product 11 as a colorless, amorphous solid.
  • RP/HPLC analysis showed three peaks for the product. Mass spectrometry confirmed the theoretical molecular weight of 475.
  • Compound 18 was prepared from compound 12 by following an analogous six-step protocol outlined above for the preparation of compound 10 from compound 4 (hydrazinolysis, benzylsulfonation, ozonolysis, oxidation, coupling and hydrogenation; see Examples 5 to 10) .
  • Example 15 A solution of the compound of Example 15 (5 g, 17 . 8 mmole) in ethanol (24 mL) , acetic acid (6 mL) and water ( 6 mL) was hydrogenated over platinum oxide (500 mg) at 45 psi for three hours .
  • the catalyst was filtered off and the filtrate concentrated under vacuum to an oily residue (6.89 g) which was used in the next step (Example 17) without further purification.
  • Thin-layer chromatography yielded two spots corresponding to two diastereomers with Rf values of 0.16 and 0.26, respectively (silica gel; 4:1:1 n-butanol/ acetic acid/water) .
  • Example 18 The compound of Example 18 (290 mg, 0.57 mmole) was treated with 2.5 N anhydrous hydrochloric acid in ethyl acetate (2.0 mL) at ambient temperature for one hour. The solvent was removed under vacuum to a sticky-white solid (260 mg) . This solid was used in the next step (Example 9) without further purification. ⁇ -H NMR spectrum taken in CD3OD showed no t-butoxycarbonyl protons at 1.4 ppm.
  • the solution is stirred at ambient temperature for about twenty hours.
  • the solvent is removed under vacuum and the resulting residue is dissolved in a 9:1 mixture of dichloromethane/isopropanol (40 mL) and washed two times each with 15 mL portions of IN sodium bisulfate, saturated sodium bicarbonate and saturated sodium chloride.
  • the organic layer is dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and concentrated under vacuum to give the title compound.
  • the product is a mix of diastereomers at Pi and has a calculated molecular weight of 875.05.
  • the reaction mixtue is stirred for about 5 minutes at O'C, then about 85 minutes at ambient temperature, and then is quenched with 60 L water.
  • the water layer is extracted twice with diethyl ether (10 mL portions) and subjected to HPLC using a 47 X 300 mm reverse phase column continuing a C-18 resin comprised of 10 micron-size gel particles with a 300 angstrom pore size.
  • the column is eluted with a gradient ranging from 15% to 30% acetonitrile in water (containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) .
  • the HPLC fractions will yield fast moving and slow moving peaks containing the two diastereomers of the title compound.
  • the fractions containing each diastereomer when pooled, then lyophilized, will give the two diastereomers of the title compound, (28a and 28b) .
  • Step 1 A solution of carbonyldiimidazole (16.2 g, 0.10 mole) in 225 mL of dimethylformamide was prepared at room temperature and allowed to stir under nitrogen. A solution of t-butyl carbazate (13.2 g, 0.100 moles) in 225 mL dimethylformamide was then added dropwise over a 30 minute period. Next, diphenylmethylamine (18.3 g, 0.10 moles) was added over a 30 minute period. The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature under nitrogen for one hour. Water (10 mL) was added and this mixture was concentrated to about 150 mL under vacuum. This solution was poured into 500 mL water and extracted with 400 mL of ethyl acetate.
  • Example 24 The compound of Example 24 (35) (48.1 g, 0.13 mmole) was dissolved in acetone (800 mL) . Iodomethane (18.3 mL, 0.19 mole, 1.5 equivalents) was added, and the solution was refluxed for 30 minutes. The solution was cooled to room temperature, and the intermediate thioimidate was filtered, dried and dissolved in methanol (500 mL) . Ammonium acetate
  • Example 28 The compound of Example 28 (39) (0.58 g, 1.9 mmole), the compound of Example 23 (410 mg, 1.15 mmole) and sodium acetate trihydrate (188 mg, 1.38 mmole) were refluxed in 75% aqueous ethanol (10 mL) for 1 hour. After the reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature, it was diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) , washed with 1.0N HCl (5 mL) , water (5 mL) , saturated sodium bicarbonate (5 mL) and brine (2x5 mL) , and dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate.
  • Example 29 The compound of Example 29 (40) (750 mg, 1.9 mmole) was treated with 50% trifluoroacetic acid/dichloromethane (3 mL) for 30 minutes at room temperature. The reaction mixture was added dropwise to ether (50 mL) . The solution was allowed to stand at 4°C for 18 hours. The product was filtered, and dried under vacuum to yield 600 mg (79% yield) of the title compound as an off-white solid. Analysis calculated for C 34 H 38 N 6 04S-1.3CF3C0H: C, 56.72; H> 5.11; N, 10.84.
  • Example 30 After 30 minutes, the compound of Example 30 (41) (363 mg, 0.49 mmole) is added. After an additional 22 hours, the reaction mixture is diluted with water (25 mL) and brine (25 mL) . The product is filtered and dissolved in ethyl acetate (125 mL) . The solution is washed with 10% citric acid, water, saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine, and is dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate. The solvent is removed under vacuum. The resulting residue is chromatographed by flash chromatography on silica gel to give the title compound.
  • Example 31 The compound of Example 31 (42) (100 mg) is treated with hydrofluoric acid/anisole (9:1) for 30 minutes at -20°C and 0°C for 30 minutes. After removal of the hydrofluoric acid, the resulting residue is dissolved in 20% aqueous acetic acid and washed with diethyl ether. The aqueous layer is lyophilized to a powder, then is purified by preparative HPLC (C-18, eluting with 10-40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) to give the title compound.
  • preparative HPLC C-18, eluting with 10-40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid
  • Example 32 The compound of Example 32 (43) (50 mg, 32 micromoles) is dissolved in methanol (1 mL) and 1% aqueous trifluoroacetic acid (5 mL) , then formalin (0.23 mL) is added. After 40 minutes, the solution is filtered through a 2 micron filter, diluted to a volume of 15 mL with water, and then is purified by preparative HPLC (C-18, eluting with 10- 40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) . The fractions containing the title compound are pooled and lyophilized to give the title compound.
  • preparative HPLC C-18, eluting with 10- 40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid
  • Enzyme activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate Pefachrome t-PA (CH3S02-D-hexahydrotyrosine-glycyl- L-arginine-p-Nitroanilide) , obtained from Pentapharm Ltd. The substrate was reconstituted in deionized water prior to use. Purified human alpha-thrombin (3000U/mg specific activity) was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. The buffer used for all assays was HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodivim chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin) .
  • the assay for Ki determinations was conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 100 microliters of HBSA or the test compound at a specified concentration diluted in HBSA (or HBSA alone for V 0 (uninhibited velocity) measurement), and 100 microliters of the chromogenic substrate (750 ⁇ M, 5X Km) .
  • 50 microliters of alpha-thrombin diluted in HBSA were added to the wells, yielding a final concentration of 0.2 nM in a total volume of 250 microliters.
  • Velocities of chromogenic substrate hydrolysis which occurred over 60 minutes were measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader.
  • Ki values were determined for test compounds using the relationships developed by Williams and Morrison, Methods in Enzymology, 61: 437 (1979) using steady state velocities (V s ) measured over 60 minutes. The extent of substrate hydrolysis was less than 5% over the course of this assay.
  • Table 1 below gives the Ki values for the compounds of Examples 11 and 14. The data show the utility of these compounds as potent in vitro inhibitors of human alpha- thrombin.
  • rt-PA tissue plasminogen activator
  • aPC activated protein C
  • trypsin trypsin
  • the buffer used for all assays was HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodium chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin).
  • the assay for IC50 determinations was conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 50 microliters of HBSA, 50 microliters of the test compound at a specified concentration (covering a broad concentration range) diluted in HBSA (or HBSA alone for V 0 (uninhibited velocity) measurement) , and 50 microliters of the enzyme diluted in HBSA. Following a 30-minute incubation at ambient temperature, 50 microliters of the substrate at the concentrations specified below were added to the wells, yielding a final total volume of 200 microliters.
  • the initial velocity of chromogenic substrate hydrolysis was measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized.
  • the concentration of added inhibitor which caused a 50% decrease in the initial rate of hydrolysis was defined as the IC50 value .
  • Enzyme activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, Pefachrome t-PA (CH3S ⁇ 2-D-hexahydrotyrosine- glycyl-L-Arginine-p-nitroaniline, obtained from Pentapharm
  • the substrate was reconstituted in deionized water prior to use.
  • Purified human ⁇ -thrombin was obtained from
  • HBSA HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodium chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin) .
  • IC50 determinations were conducted where HBSA (50 ⁇ l) , ⁇ -thrombin (50 ⁇ l) (the final enzyme concentration is 0.5 nM) and inhibitor (50 ⁇ l) (covering a broad concentration range) were combined in appropriate wells and incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature prior to the addition of substrate Pefachrome-t-PA (50 ⁇ l) (the final substrate concentration is 250 ⁇ M, about 5 times Km) .
  • the initial velocity of Pefachrome t-PA hydrolysis was measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized.
  • rt-PA Recombinant tissue plasminogen activator
  • rt-PA catalytic activity was determined using the substrate, Pefachrome t-PA (CH3S ⁇ 2-D-hexahydrotyrosine- glycyl-L-arginine-p-nitroanilide, obtained from Pentapharm Ltd.). The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 500 micromolar (about 3-times Km) .
  • Human rt-PA (Activase®) was obtained from Genentech Inc. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM.
  • Plasmin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2366 (L-pyro-Glu-Pro-Arg-pNa-HCl), which was obtained from DiaPharma Group. The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 300 micromolar (about 2.5-times Km) . Purified human plasmin was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM.
  • Activated Protein C aPC catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, Pefachrome PC (delta-carbobenzloxy-D- lysine-L-prolyl-L-arginine-p-nitroanilide) , obtained from Pentapharm Ltd. ) .
  • the substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 400 micromolar (about 3- times Km) .
  • Purified human aPC was obtained from Hematologic Technologies, Inc. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM. 5.
  • Chymotrypsin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2586 (methoxy-succinyl-L-arginine-L- prolyl-L-tyrosyl-p-nitroanilide) , which was obtained from DiaPharma Group.
  • the substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 100 micromolar (about 9- times Km) .
  • Purified (3X-crystallized; CDI) bovine pancreatic a-chymotrypsin was obtained from Worthington Biochemical Corp. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 0.5 nM.
  • Trypsin Trypsin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2222 (benzoyl-L-isoleucine-L- glutamic acid- (gamma-methyl ester) -L-arginine-p- nitroanilide) , which was obtained from DiaPharma Group.
  • the substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 250 micromolar (about 4-times Km) .
  • Purified (3X- crystallized; TRL3) bovine pancreatic trypsin was obtained from Worthington Biochemical Corp. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 0.5 nM.
  • Factor Xa catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate S-2765 (N-benzyloxycarbonyl-D-arginine- L-glycine-L-arginine-p-nitroaniline) , obtained from DiaPharma Group (Franklin, OH) . All substrates were reconstituted in deionized water prior to use. The final concentration of S- 2765 was 250 ⁇ M (about 5-times Km) .
  • Purified human Factor X was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. (South Bend, IN) and Factor Xa (FXa) was activated and prepared from it as described [Bock, P.E., Craig, P.A., Olson, S.T., and Singh, P. Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 273:375-388 (1989)]. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay, in which the final concentration was 0.25 nM.
  • Table 2 lists the determined IC50 values for the compounds of Examples 11 and 14 as inhibitors of some of the enzymes listed above and demonstrates the high degree of specificity for the inhibition of alpha-thrombin compared to these related serine proteases.
  • Table 2 50 values for the inhibition of human alpha thrombin amidolvtic activity compared to selected serine proteases for compounds of Example 11 and 14
  • ex. vivo anticoagulant effects of compounds of the present invention are determined by measuring the prolongation of the activated partial thromboplastin time (APTT) over a broad concentration range of the added inhibitor, using pooled normal human and rat plasma.
  • APTT activated partial thromboplastin time
  • Fresh frozen citrated pooled normal human plasma is obtained from George King Biomedical, Overland Park, KA.
  • Pooled normal rat plasma is prepared from citrated whole blood collected from anesthetized rats using standard procedures. The plasma is flash frozen and stored at -80°C until use.
  • the assay is conducted by making a series of dilutions of the test compounds into 100 ⁇ l rapidly thawed plasma followed by adding 200 microliters of APTT reagent and calcium chloride, to the wells of the assay carousel. Compounds that prolong the APTT in a dose-dependent manner are considered to demonstrate an anticoagulant effect.
  • the antithrombotic (prevention of thrombus formation) properties of compounds of the present invention are evaluated using the following established experimental model of acute vascular thrombosis which is a rat model of FeCl3 ⁇ induced platelet-dependent arterial thrombosis.
  • Male Harlan Sprague Dawley rats (420-450 g) are acclimated at least 72 hours prior to use and fasted for 12 hours prior to surgery with free access to water.
  • the animals are prepared, anesthetized with Nembutal followed by the insertion of catheters for blood pressure monitoring, drug and anesthesia delivery.
  • the left carotid artery is isolated by making a midline cervical incision followed by blunt dissection and spreading techniques to separate a 2 cm segment of the vessel from the carotid sheath.
  • a silk suture is inserted under the proximal and distal ends of the isolated vessel to provide clearance for the placement of a ultrasonic flow probe (Transonic) around the proximal end of the vessel. The probe is then secured with a stationary arm.
  • Transonic ultrasonic flow probe
  • test compound is administered as a single intravenous bolus at doses of about 0.3 to 5.0 mg/kg after placement of the flow probe and 5 minutes prior to the thrombogenic stimulus.
  • a 3mm diameter piece of filter paper (Whatman #3) soaked with 10 microliters of a 35% solution of fresh FeCl3 (made up in water) is applied the segment of isolated carotid artery distal to . the flow probe. Blood pressure, blood flow, heart rate, and respiration are monitored for 60 minutes.
  • the incidence of occlusion (defined as the attainment of zero blood flow) is recorded as the primary end point.
  • the efficacy of test compounds as an antithrombotic agent in preventing thrombus formation in this in vivo model is demonstrated by the reduction in the incidence of thrombotic occlusion.
  • the effective dose which prevents 50% of thrombotic occlusions in this model (ED50) can be determined from the above data by plotting the incidence of occlusion versus the dose administered. This allows a direct comparison of the antithrombotic efficacy of test compounds with other antithrombotic agents which have also been evaluated in this model as .
  • Table 3 lists the ED50 values for several well known anticoagulant agents in this model (Heparin-Hirsh, J. N.
  • a ED5o is defined as the dose that prevents the incidence of complete thrombotic occlusion in 50% of animals tested.
  • the in vivo comparison of compounds of the present invention with the clinically effective antithrombotic agents Standard Heparin, Argatroban, and Hirulog tm in the same rodent model of experimental thrombosis coupled with demonstrated anticoagulant effects of the present compounds in both rat and human plasma described above in Example C would lead one skilled in the art to conclude that this compound will be an effective antithrombotic agent in humans .
  • Elastase catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate Elastase Substrate I (MeOSuc-Ala-Ala- Pro-Val-p-nitroanaline, obtained from Calbiochem) .
  • the substrate was reconstituted with 10% DMSO and assay buffer.
  • Human Neutrophil Elastase was obtained from Calbiochem and diluted in the assay uffer prior to use.
  • the assay buffer diluted in the assay buffer prior to use.
  • the assay buffe was HBS (10 mM HEPES, 150 mM sodium chloride, pH 7.5) with 0.1% Tween 80 and 10% DMSO.
  • the DMSO is necessary to keep the substrate from precipitating during the course of the assay.
  • IC50 determinations were conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 50 microliters of the test compound at a specified concentration (covering a broad concentration range) diluted in buffer (or buffer along for V Q (uninhibited velocity) measurement) , and
  • the initial velocity of substrate hydrolysis was measured by the change of absorbance at 405 nM using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized.
  • the concentration of added inhibitor which caused a 50% decrease in the initial rate of hydrolysis was defined as the IC50 value.

Abstract

The present invention provides peptide aldehydes having an 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenyl acetamide group as part of the peptide backbone and an arginine group or analog at P1. These compounds are potent and specific or inhibitors of thrombin. Their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof, and methods of using them as therapeutic agents for disease states in mammals characterized by abnormal thrombosis are also described. Also described are 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenyl-acetamide derivatives having in history activity towards proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class.

Description

SUBSTITUTED 3-AMINO-2-HYDROXYPHENYLACETAMIDE DERIVATIVES AS ENZYME INHIBITORS (II)
Technical Field
In one aspect, the present invention relates to compounds which are potent and specific inhibitors of thrombin. In another aspect, the present invention relates to novel peptide aldehydes, their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, and pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof which are useful as potent and specific inhibitors of blood coagulation in vitro and in vivo in mammals. In yet another aspect, the invention relates to methods of using these inhibitors as therapeutic agents for disease states in mammals characterized by abnormal thrombosis .
Background
Normal hemostasis is the result of a complex balance between the processes of clot formation (blood coagulation) and clot dissolution (fibrinolysis) . The complex interactions between blood cells, specific plasma proteins and the vascular surface, maintain the fluidity of blood unless injury and blood loss occur.
Blood coagulation is the culmination of a series of amplified reactions in which several specific zymogens of serine proteases in plasma are activated by limited proteolysis. Nemerson, Y. and Nossel, H.L., Ann. Rey. Med. , 33; 479 (1982) . This series of reactions results in the formation of an insoluble fibrin matrix which is required for the stabilization of the primary hemostatic plug. The interaction and propagation of the activation reactions occurs through the extrinsic and intrinsic pathways of coagulation.
These pathways are highly inter-dependent and converge in the formation of the serine protease, Factor Xa. Factor Xa catalyzes the penultimate step in the blood coagulation cascade which is the formation of the serine protease thrombin. This step occurs following the assembly of the prothrombinase complex which is composed of factor Xa, the non-enzymatic co-factor Va and the substrate prothrombin assembled on the surface of adhered, activated platelets or systemically circulating membranous microparticles .
Proteolytic activation of zymogen factor X to its catalytically active form, factor Xa, can occur by either the intrinsic or extrinsic coagulation pathways.
The intrinsic pathway is referred to as "intrinsic" because everything needed for clotting is in the blood. Saito, H., "Normal Hemostatic Mechanisms", Disorders of Hemostasis. pp. 27-29, Grune & Stratton, Inc. (0. D. Ratnoff, M.D. and C D. Forbes, M.D. edit. 1984) . This pathway is comprised of the zymogen serine proteases, factors IX and XI, and the non- enzymatic co-factor, factor VIII. The initiation of the intrinsic pathway results in the activation of factor XI to XIa. Factor XIa catalyzes the activation of factor IX to factor IXa which in combination with the activated form of factor VIII on an appropriate phospholipid surface, results in the formation of the tenase complex. This complex also catalyzes the formation of the serine protease, factor Xa, from its zymogen, factor X which subsequently results in clot formation.
The extrinsic pathway is referred to as "extrinsic" because the tissue factor which binds to and facilitates the activation of factor VII comes from outside the blood. Saito, ∑d,. The major components of this pathway are the zymogen serine protease, factor VII, and the membrane bound protein, tissue factor. The latter serves as the requisite non- enzymatic co-factor for this enzyme. The initiation of this pathway is thought to be an autocatalytic event resulting from the activation of zymogen factor VII by trace levels of activated factor VII (factor Vila), both of which are bound to newly exposed tissue factor on membrane surfaces at sites of vascular damage. The factor Vila/tissue factor complex directly catalyzes the formation of the serine protease, factor Xa, from its zymogen, factor X. Exposure of blood to injured tissue initiates blood clotting by the extrinsic pathway.
The formation of thrombin is catalyzed by factor Xa following the assembly of the catalytic prothrombinase complex as reviewed by Mann, K. G. et. al., "Surface-Dependent Reactions of the Vitamin K-Dependent Enzyme Complexes", Blood. 76: 1-16 (1990) . This complex is composed of factor Xa, the non-enzymatic co-factor Va and the substrate prothrombin all assembled on an appropriate phospholipid surface. The requirement of a macromolecular complex for efficient catalysis results in the protection of factor Xa from natural anticoagulant mechanisms such as heparin-antithrombin III mediated inhibition. Teite, J. M. and Rosenberg, R. D., "Protection of Factor Xa from neutralization by the heparin- antithrombin complex" , £. Clin. Invest . , 71: 1383-1391(1983). In addition, sequestration of factor Xa in the prothrombinase complex also renders it resistant to inhibition by exogenous heparin therapy which also requires antithrombin III to elicit its anticoagulant effect.
Thrombin is the primary mediator of thrombus formation. Thrombin acts directly to cause formation of insoluble fibrin from circulating fibrinogen. In addition, thrombin activates the zymogen factor XIII to the active transglutaminase factor Xllla which acts to covalently stabilize the growing thrombus by crosslinking the fibrin strands. orand, . and Konishi, K., Arch. Bioche . Biophvs . , 105: 58 (1964). Beyond it's direct role in the formation and stabilization of fibrin rich clots, the enzyme has been reported to have profound bioregulatory effects on a number of cellular components within the vasculature and blood. Shuman, M.A., Ann. NY Acad. ≤Ci . , 40 : 349 ( 1986 ) .
It is believed that thrombin is the most potent agonist of platelet activation, and it has been demonstrated to be the primary pathophysiologic-mediator of platelet-dependent arterial thrombus formation. Edit, J.F. et al., . Clin.
Invest. , 84: 18 (1989). Thrombin-mediated platelet activation leads to ligand-induced inter-platelet aggregation principally due to the bivalent interactions between adhesive ligands such as fibrinogen and fibronectin with platelet integrin receptors such as glycoprotein lib/Ilia which assume their active conformation following thrombin activation. Berndt, M.C. and Phillips, D.R., Platelets in Bioloαv and Pathology, pp 43-74, Elsevier/North Holland Biomedical Press (Gordon, J.L. edit. 1981) . Thrombin-activated platelets can also support further thrombin production through the assembly of new prothrombinase and tenase (factor IXa, factor VTIIa and factor X) catalytic complexes on the membrane surface of intact activated platelets and platelet-derived microparticles, following thrombin-mediated activation of the non-enzymatic cofactors V and VIII, respectively. Tans, G. et al., Blood. 77: 2641
(1991) . This positive feedback process results in the local generation of large concentrations of thrombin within the vicinity of the thrombus which supports further thrombus growth and extension. Mann, K.G. et al., Blood. 76: 1 (1990). In contrast to its prothrombotic effects, thrombin has been shown to influence other aspects of he ostasis. These include its effect as an important physiological anticoagulant. The anticoagulant effect of thrombin is expressed following binding of thrombin to the endothelial cell membrane glycoprotein, thrombomodulin. This is thought to result in an alteration of the substrate specificity of thrombin thereby allowing it to recognize and proteolytically activate circulating protein C to give activated protein C (aPC) . Musci, G. et al., Biochemistry. 21: 769 (1988) . aPC is a serine protease which selectively inactivates the non- enzymatic co-factors Va and Villa resulting in a down- regulation of thrombin formation by the prothrombinase. and tenase catalytic complexes, respectively. Esmon, C ., Science. 235 : 1348 (1987) . The activation of protein C by thrombin in the absence of thrombomodulin is poor. Thrombin has also been shown to be a potent direct mitogen for a number of. cell types, including cells of mesenchymal origin such as vascular smooth muscle cells. Chen, L.B. and Buchanan, J.M. , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA. 72 : 131 (1975) . The direct interaction of thrombin with vascular smooth muscle also results in vasoconstriction. Walz, D.A. et al., Proc. Soc . Expl . Biol. Med. , 180: 518 (1985). Thrombin acts as a direct secretagogue inducing the release of a number of bioactive substances from vascular endothelial cells including tissue plasminogen activator. Levin, E.G. et al., Thro b . Haemost .. 56 : 115 (1986). In addition to these direct effects on vascular cells, the enzyme can indirectly elaborate potent mitogenic activity on vascular smooth muscle cells by the release of several potent growth factors (e.g. platelet- derived growth factor and epidermal growth factor) from platelet a-granules following thrombin-induced activation. Ross, R., E. Engl. J. Msd. , 211: 408 (1986).
Many significant disease states are related to abnormal hemostasis. With respect to the coronary arterial vasculature, abnormal thrombus formation due to the rupture of an established atherosclerotic plaque is the major cause of acute myocardial infarction and unstable angina. Moreover, treatment of an occlusive coronary thrombus by either thrombolytic therapy or percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty (PTCA) is often accompanied by an acute thrombotic reclosure of the affected vessel which requires immediate resolution. With respect to the venous vasculature, a high percentage of patients undergoing major surgery in the lower extremities or the abdominal area suffer from thrombus formation in the venous vasculature which can result in reduced blood flow to the affected extremity and a predisposition to pulmonary embolism. Disseminated intravascular coagulopathy commonly occurs within both vascular systems during septic shock, certain viral infections and cancer and is characterized by the rapid consumption of coagulation factors and systemic coagulation which results in the formation of life-threatening thrombi occurring throughout the vasculature leading to widespread organ failure.
Pathogenic thrombosis in the arterial vasculature is a major clinical concern in today's medicine. It is the leading cause of acute myocardial infarction which is one of the leading causes of death in the western world. Recurrent arterial thrombosis also remains one of the leading causes of failure following enzymatic or mechanical recanalization of occluded coronary vessels using thrombolytic agents or percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty (PTCA) , respectively. Ross, A.M., Thrombosis in Cardiovascular Disorder, p. 327, W.B. Saunders Co. (Fuster, V. and Verstraete, M. edit. 1991); Califf, R.M. and Willerson, J.T. , Id. at p 389. In contrast to thrombotic events in the venous vasculature, arterial thrombosis is the result of a complex interaction between fibrin formation resulting from the blood coagulation cascade and cellular components, particularly platelets, which make up a large percentage of arterial thrombi. Heparin, the most widely used clinical anticoagulant administered i.v., has not been shown to be universally effective in the treatment or prevention of acute arterial thrombosis or rethrombosis . Prins, M.H. and Hirsh, J. , J_. Am. CQll- Cardiol .. ≤2: 3A (1991).
Besides the unpredictable, recurrent thrombotic reocclusion which commonly occurs following PTCA, a profound restenosis of the recanalized vessel occurs in 30 to 40% of patients 1 to 6 months following this procedure. Califf, R.M. et al.', J. . Coll. Cardiol .. 17: 2B (1991). These patients require further treatment with either a repeat PTCA or coronary artery bypass surgery to relieve the newly formed stenosis. Restenosis of a mechanically damaged vessel is not a thrombotic process but instead is the result of a hyperproliferative response in the surrounding smooth muscle cells which over time results in a decreased luminal diameter of the affected vessel due to increased muscle mass. ∑ςi . As for arterial thrombosis, there is currently no effective phar acologic treatment for the prevention of vascular restenosis following mechanical recanalization.
The need for safe and effective therapeutic anticoagulants has in one aspect focused on the role of the serine protease thrombin in blood coagulation. Most preferred natural substrates for thrombin are reported to contain an uncharged amino acid in the P3 recognition subsite. For example, the thrombin cleavage site on the Aa chain of fibrinogen, which is the primary physiological substrate for thrombin, is reported to contain a glycine residue in this position while the cleavage site on the Bb chain contains a serine, as shown below: P4 P3 P2 PI PI
Gly-Gly-Val-Arg/Gly Fibrinogen Aa Chain [SEQ. ID. NO. 1] Phe-Ser-Ala-Arg/Gly Fibrinogen Bb Chain
[SEQ. ID. NO. 2]
Peptidyl derivatives having an uncharged residue in the P3 position are said to bind to the active site of thrombin and thereby inhibit the conversion of fibrinogen to fibrin and cellular activation have been reported. These derivatives have either an aldehyde, chloromethyl ketone or boronic acid functionality associated with the PI amino acid. For example, substrate-like peptidyl derivatives such as D-phenylalanyl- prolyl-argininal (D-Phe-Pro-Arg-al) , D-phenylalanyl-prolyl- arginine-chloromethyl ketone (P-PACK) and acetyl-D- phenylalanyl-prolyl-boroarginine (Ac- (D-Phe) -Pro-boroArg) have been reported to inhibit thrombin by directly binding to the active site of the enzyme. Bajusz, S., Symposia Biologica Hungarica. 23.: 277 (1984), Bajusz, S. et al, £. }ted. Chem. P
H: 1729 (1990) and Bajusz, S. et al., Int. JI. Peptide Protein Res. 12: 217 (1970); Kettner, C. and Shaw, E., Methods Enzvmol . , £Q: 826 (1987), Kettner, C. et al . , EP 293,881 (published December 7, 1988), Kettner, C, et al., J. Biol. Chem.. 265: 18209 (1990). These molecules have been reported to be potent anticoagulants in the prevention of platelet-rich arterial thrombosis. Kelly, A.B. et al., Thromb. Haemostas .. 65: 736 at abstract 257 (1991) . Other peptidyl aldehydes have been proposed or reported as inhibitors of thrombin. Bey, P. et al., EP 363,284 (published April 11, 1990) and Balasubramanian, N. et al., EP 526,877 (published February 10, 1993) .
Peptidyl compounds which are said to be active site inhibitors of thrombin but which differ in structure from those containing a uncharged amino acid in the P3 recognition subsite have been reported.
The compound, Argatroban (also called 2R, 4R-4-methyl-l- [N-2- (3-methyl-l,2, 3 , 4-tetrahydro-8-quinolinesulfonyl) -L- argininy]-2-piperdinecarboxylic acid), is also reported to bind directly to the active site of thrombin and has been thought to be the most potent and selective compound in the class of non-peptidyl inhibitors of this enzyme. Okamoto, S. et al., Biochem. Biophvs . Res. Commun.. 101: 440 (1981). Argatroban has been reported to be a potent antithrombotic agent in several experimental models of acute arterial thrombosis. Jang, I.K. et al., in both Circulation. 81: 219 (1990) and ≤irc.. Baa., £7: 1552 (1990).
Peptidyl compounds which are said to be inhibitors of thrombin and whose mode of action is thought to be by binding to both the active site and another site on the enzyme have been reported. Hirudin and certain peptidyl derivatives of hirudin have been reported to inhibit both conversion of fibrinogen to fibrin and platelet activation by binding to either both the active site and exo site, or the exo site only, of thrombin. Markwardt, F., Thromb. Haemostas .. .66: 141 (1991) . Hirudin is reported to be a 65 amino acid polypeptide originally isolated from leech salivary gland extracts. It is said to be one of the most potent inhibitors of thrombin known. Marki, W.E. and Wallis, R.B., Thromb. Haemostas .. 64: 344 (1990) . It has been reported to inhibit thrombin by binding to both its anion-binding exo-site and to its catalytic active site which are distinct and physically distant from each other. Rydel, T.J. et al., Science. 249:277 (1990) . Hirudin has been reported to be a potent antithrombotic agent in vivo. Markwardt, F. et al., Phar azie. 43 : 202 (1988); Kelly, A.B. et al., Blood. 77: (1991) . In addition to its antithrombotic effects, hirudin has been reported to also effectively inhibit smooth muscle proliferation and the associated restenosis following mechanical damage to a atherosclerotic rabbit femoral artery. Sarembock, I.J. et al., Circulation. 84: 232 (1991). Hirugen has been reported to be a peptide derived from the anionic carboxy-terminus of hirudin. It is reported to bind only to the anion binding exo-site of thrombin and thereby inhibit the formation of fibrin but not the catalytic turnover of small synthetic substrates which have access to the unblocked active site of the enzyme. Maraganore, J.M. et al., J. Biol. Chem.. 264: 8692 (1989); Naski, M.C. et al., £. Biol. Chem.. 265: 13484 (1990). The region of hirudin represented by hirugen has been reported, as according to by x-ray crystallographic analysis, to bind directly to the exo site of thrombin. Skrzypczak-Jankun, E. et al., Thromb.
Haemostas .. 65: 830 at abstract 507 (1991). Moreover, the binding of hirugen has also been reported to enhance the catalytic turnover of certain small synthetic substrates by thrombin, indicating that a conformational change in the enzyme active site may accompany occupancy of the exo-site. Liu, L.W. et al., £. Biol. Chem.. 2££:16977 (1991). Hirugen also is reported to block thrombin-mediated platelet aggregation. Jakubowski, J.A. and Maraganore, J.M., Blood. 21: 399 (1990) . A group of synthetic chimeric molecules comprised of a hirugen-like sequence linked by a glycine-spacer region to the peptide, D-phenylalanyl-prolyl-arginine, which is based on a preferred substrate recognition site for thrombin, has been termed to be hirulog. Maraganore et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,196,404 (March 23, 1993). The hirugen-like sequence is said to be linked to this peptide through the C-terminal end of the peptide. Maraganone, J.M. et al., Biochemistry. 29: 7095 (1990) . The hirulogs have been reported to be an effective antithrombotic agents in preventing both fibrin-rich and platelet-rich thrombosis. Maraganone, J.M. et al., Thromb. Haemostas .. 65: 651 at abstract 17 (1991).
Certain benzamidines have been reported to inhibit thrombin though non-selectively. 4-amidinophenylpyruvic acid (APPA) has been reported to be a thrombin inhibitor with low toxicity and favourable pharmacokinetics . However, this compound was reported to be non-selective, inhibiting trypsin, plasmin and kallikrein. Markwardt et al., Thromb. Res.. 1:243-52 (1972). Other benzamidine-derived structures which have been reported to inhibit thrombin include the cylic amides of Na-substituted 4-amidinophenylalanine and 2- amino-5- (4-amidinophenyl) -1-valeric acid. The inhibitory constant displayed by these compounds was reported to be in the micromolar range. Markwardt et al., Thromb. Res.. 12:425-31 (1980). Moreover, derivatives of 4- amidinophenylalanine whose a-amino group is linked to the arylsulfonyl residue via an w-aminoalkylcarboxylic acid as spacer have also been assessed for their inhibitory effect. Among these Na-(2-naphthylsulphonylglycyl) -4-amidinophenylalanine piperidide (a-NAPAP) has been reported to possess an affinity for thrombin (Ki=6 x 10"9 M) . Banner et al., J. Bifil. Chem.. 2££: 20085 (1991) and Sturzebecher et al., Thromb. Res.. 21:635-42 (1983).
Certain bis-benzamidines have been reported to inhibit thrombin. The antithrombin activity of bis-benzamidines was reported to increase with the length and bulkiness of the central chain. However, these compounds were reported to be generally toxic in the micromolar range where they are also inhibitory. Geratz et. al., Thromb. Diath . Haemorrh.. 21:154-67 (1973); Geratz et. al., J. Meςi . Chem.. l£:970-5 (1973); Geratz et. al., . Mg£. Chem. ■ 11:634-9 (1976); Walsmann et. al., Acta βiol . Med. Germ.. ϋ:Kl-8 (1976); and Hauptmann et. al., Acta Biol. Med. Germ. , 15:635-44 (1976). Certain amidino-bearing aromatic ring structures such a b-naphthamidines have been reported to possess modest antithrombin and anticoagulant activity. This class of compounds include the non-selective 6-amidino-2-naphthyl- 4- guanidinobenzoate dimethanesulfonate (FUT 175). Fuji et al., Biochim. Biophvs . Acta. 661:342-5 (1981); and Hitomi et. al., Haemostasis. 11:164-8 (1985).
Certain phenylguanidines have been reported to inhibit thrombin. Derivatives of 4-guanidinophenylalanine with inhibitory constants in the micromolar range have been reported to inhibit thrombin. This class includes the Na- tosylated and dansylated 4-guanidino phenylalanine piperidides. Claeson et. al., Thromb. Haemostas . r 11:53 (1983). Another compound, [ethyl p- (6-guanidinohexanoyloxy) benzoate] methane sulfonate (FOY) was reported to be a non- selective competitive inhibitor of thrombin. Ohno et al., Thromb . Res.. 11:579-588 (1980).
Certain compounds having inhibitory activity toward serine proteases, including thrombin, factor Xa, and trypsin, are disclosed within the following commonly assigned United States patents or published PCT applications: US 5,371,072; 5,492,895; 5,534,498; 5,597,804; 5,637,599; 5,646,165; 5,656,600; 5,656,645; WO 94/13693; WO 95/35311; WO 95/35313; WO 96/19493.
Summary of the Invention
Novel compounds of the present invention include compounds of the formula (I) :
Figure imgf000014_0001
wherein
(a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S(0)2-#
-N(R')-S(0)2-. -C(=0)-, -OC(=0)-, -NH-C(=0)-, -P (0) (R" ) - and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is NHR', OR ' , R' , or SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of: (1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
(3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R'/ (4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R ' ,
(5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl or alkoxy, or -C02R',
(6) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -Cθ2R'»
(7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(8) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(9) aralkyl of about 7 -to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, (10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2# and/or Y3,
(11) aralkenyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 5 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, (12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
Figure imgf000016_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,
(19) perfluoroaralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and
(21)
Figure imgf000016_0002
is a 5 to 7 membered heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is -CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2- or -S-, wherein Yi, Y2, and Y3 are
(i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, -CH(CF3)2, -C(OH) (CF3) 2, -OCF3, -OCF2CF3, -0C(0)NH2, -OC(0)NHZι, -OC(0)NZιZ2, -NHC(0)Zι, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NHZi, -NHC(0)NZιZ2, -C(0)OH, -C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZι, -C(0)NZlZ2, -C(0)0Z1, -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)0H, -P(0)3(Zl)2/ -S(0)3H , S (0) mZl ι -Zχ, -OZ1# -OH, -NH2, -NHZi, and -NZ1Z2, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, and Z^ and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]_0-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 "to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms; (c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms; (d) R3 is selected from the group consisting of
Figure imgf000017_0001
where d is an integer from 0 to 5 and W is -N- or -CH-; (e) R4 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl# wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, and Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is
— v not a camphor derivative or ^-- heterocycle, ( ii) -CF3 , -CF2H, -OCF3 , or -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR8, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR8 and -S(0)pR8/ wherein Rs is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and p is 0, 1 or 2
(v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of '3 to 5 carbon atoms, (vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms,
(viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(ix) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(f) R5 s selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl. wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
—N v derivative or v—' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, or -OCF2H, and
(iii) halogen;
(g) R6 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
—N v derivative or v»-' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, or -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Zβ, wherein Z$ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg_ -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR9, an^ -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3;
(v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms;
(vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
(viii) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from o^rgen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of 6 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and
(x) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and having the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, as defined above; and
(h) R7 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above, with the
—N v proviso that Ri is not a camphor derivative or '^—z heterocycle, (ii) -CF3,or -CF2H,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2 1O/ -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2θR10 -Cθ2RlO» -SO2R10/ -CONRioRll,
(v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -Cθ2Rlθ# -SO2 1O -CONRioRll, (vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2RIO/ -SO2R10/ -CONRioRll, and
(vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2RIO -SO2 1O/ -CONRioRll, and wherein each of R10 and Rn is independently selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen; or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
Among other factors, the present invention is based on our finding that these novel compounds are active as selective inhibitors of thrombin in vivo and in vi tro. Furthermore, certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have been found to exhibit advantageous selectivity in that they are potent inhibitors of thrombin, but are much less active and much less potent in inhibiting plas in and trypsin. Certain compounds of the present invention may also have broader serine protease inhibitory activity.
According to an alternate aspect of the present invention, also provided are compounds of formula (II) which have inhibitory activity towards proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class. This aspect of the invention Is directed to compounds of formula (II) :
Figure imgf000021_0001
wherein a substituted phenol or phenyl ether is present in the compound in place of the amide bond of an inhibitor that makes hydrogen bonds to amino acid 216 in the trypsin/chymotrypsin class of serine proteases. Thus, according to this aspect of the present invention, provided are compounds of formula (II), wherein X, Ri, R2, R4, R5, Rβ , and R7 are as defined hereinabove in connection with formula (I), and (a) R12 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms optionally substituted with amino, amidino, or guanidino,
(ii) aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino,
(iii) aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino, and
(iv) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having about 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder.of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino; and (b) TS is selected from the group consisting of (i) -CHO, (ii) -C(0)CF3, (iii) -C(0)CF2CF3, (iv) -C(0)-C(0)-NHR13, (v) -C(0)-C(0)2R13,
(vi) -C(0)-C(0)-NR13R14, (vii) -B(OR13) (OR14), (viii) -C(0)CH2C1, and (ix) -C(0)R15; wherein R^3 and R^4 are independently selected from hydrogen lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur, and R-j_5 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms and heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur. In the case where TS is (vii) , additionally -0Rι3 and -OR]^ may be taken together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]qO- wherein Z3, Z4 and q are as defined in connection with formula (I) . Also included are pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (II) .
In another aspect, the present invention is directed to pharmaceutical compositions comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In yet another aspect, the present invention is directed to methods of using the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of formula (I) for the prevention of or treating. of thrombosis in a mammal suspected of having a condition of abnormal thrombosis, which comprises administering to said mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention or pharmaceutical composition comprising such a compound.
Definitions
In accordance with the present invention and as used herein, the following terms are defined to have following meanings, unless explicitly stated otherwise:
The term "alkenyl" refers to unsaturated aliphatic groups having at least one double bond.
The term "alkyl" refers to saturated aliphatic groups including straight-chain, branched-chain and cyclic groups.
The terms "alkoxy" and "alkoxyl" refer to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an alkyl group. The term "alkoxycarbonyl" refers to -C(0)OR wherein R is alkyl.
The term "aralkenyl" refers to an alkenyl group substituted with an aryl group.
The term "aralkyl" refers to an alkyl group substituted with an aryl group. Suitable aralkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl, and the like, all of which may be optionally substituted.
The term "aryl" refers to aromatic groups which have at least one ring having a conjugated pi electron system and includes carbocyclic aryl, heterocyclic aryl and biaryl groups, all of which may be optionally substituted.
The term "aryloxy" refers to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an aryl group.
The term
Figure imgf000023_0001
refers to a group having the formula, R-0-, wherein R is an aralkyl group.
The term "amino acid" refers to natural amino acids, unnatural amino acids, and amino acid analogs, all in their D and L stereoisomers if their structure allow such stereoisomeric. Natural amino acids include alanine (Ala), arginine (Arg) , asparagine (Asn) , aspartic acid (Asp) , cysteine (Cys) , glutamine (Gin) , glutamic acid (Glu) , glycine (Gly), histidine (His), isoleucine (lie), leucine (Leu), lysine (Lys) , methionine (Met) , phenylalanine (Phe) , proline (Pro) , serine (Ser) , threonine (Thr) , tryptophan (Trp) , tyrosine (Tyr) and valine (Val) . Unnatural amino acids include, but are not limited to azetidinecarboxylic acid, 2- aminoadipic acid, 3-aminoadipic acid, beta-alanine, aminopropionic acid, 2-aminobutyric acid, 4-aminobutyric acid, 6-aminocaproic acid, 2-aminoheptanoic acid, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, 3-aminoisobutyric acid, 2-aminopimelic acid, 2,4-diaminoisobutyric acid, desmosine, 2 , 2 ' -diaminopimelic acid, 2, 3-diaminopropionic acid, N- ethylglycine, N-ethylasparagine, hydroxylysine, allo- hydroxylysine, 3-hydroxyproline, 4-hydroxyproline, isodesmosine, allo-isoleucine, N-methylglycine, N- methylisoleucine, N-methylvaline, norvaline, norleucine, ornithine and pipecolic acid. Amino acid analogs include the natural and unnatural amino acids which are chemically blocked, reversibly or irreversibly, or modified on their N- terminal amino group or their side-chain groups, as for example, methionine sulfoxide, methionine sulfone,
S- (carboxymethyl) -cysteine, S- (carboxymethyl) -cysteine sulfoxide and S- (carboxymethyl) -cysteine sulfone.
The term "amino acid analog" refers to an amino acid wherein either the C-terminal carboxy group, the N-terminal amino group or side-chain functional group has been chemically modified to another functional group. For example, aspartic acid- (beta-methyl ester) is an amino acid analog of aspartic acid; N-ethylglycine is an amino acid analog of glycine; or alanine carboxamide is an amino acid analog of alanine.
The term "amino acid residue" refers to radicals having the structure: (1) -C(0)-R-NH-, wherein R typically is -
CH(R')-, wherein R' is H or a carbon containing substituent;
or (2)
Figure imgf000025_0001
, wherein p is 1, 2 or 3 representing the azetidinecarboxylic acid, proline or pipecolic acid residues, respectively.
"Biaryl" refers to phenyl substituted by carbocyclic or heterocyclic aryl as defined herein, ortho, meta or para to the point of attachment of the phenyl ring.
"Brine" refers to an aqueous saturated solution of sodium chloride.
"Carbocyclic aryl" refers to aromatic groups wherein the ring atoms on the aromatic ring are carbon atoms. Carbocyclic aryl groups include monocyclic carbocyclic aryl groups and naphthyl groups, all of which may be optionally substituted. Suitable carbocyclic aryl groups include phenyl and naphthyl. Suitable substituted carbocyclic aryl groups include indene and phenyl substituted by one to two substituents such being advantageously lower alkyl, hydroxy, lower alkoxy, lower alkoxycarbonyl, halogen, trifluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, nitro, and cyano. Substituted naphthyl refers to naphthyl, more preferably 1- or 2-naphthyl, substituted by Y^, Y2 and/or Y3 as defined in connection with formula (I) hereinabove..
"Cycloalkenyl" refers to a cyclic alkenyl group. Suitable cycloalkenyl groups include, for example, cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl .
"Cycloalkyl" refers to a cyclic alkyl group. Suitable cycloalkyl groups include, for example, cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, and cycloheptyl. "Cyclohexylmethyl" refers to a cyclohexyl group attached to CH2.
The term "halogen" refers to fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine. "Heteroaralkenyl" refers to an alkenyl group substitued with a heteroaryl, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems. Preferably the alkenyl group has from 2 to about 6 carbon of atoms.
"Heteroaralkyl" refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heteroaryl, such as picolyl, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems. Preferably the alkyl group has from 1 to about 6 carbon atoms. "Heteroaryl" refers to aryl groups having from 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems. Suitable heteroatoms include oxygen, nitrogen, S(0) , wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and suitable heterocyclic aryls include furanyl, thienyl, pyridyl, pyrrolyl, pyrimidyl, pyrazinyl, imidazolyl, and the like.
"Heterocyclo" refers to a reduced heterocyclic ring system comprised of carbon, nitrogen, oxygen and/or sulfur atoms, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C.
Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B.
Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems.
"Heterocycloalkyl" refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heterocyclo group, and includes those heterocyclic systems described in "Handbook of Chemistry and Physics", 49th edition, 1968, R.C. Weast, editor; The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, OH. See particularly Section C, Rules for Naming Organic Compounds, B. Fundamental Heterocyclic Systems. Preferably the alkyl group has from 1 to about 6 carbon atoms . The term "lower" referred to herein in connection with organic radicals or groups defines such radicals or groups with one and up to and including 5 carbon atoms, preferably up to and including 4 carbon atoms, and advantageously one or two carbon atoms. Such radicals or groups may be straight chain or branched chain.
"Perfluoroalkyl" refers to an alkyl group which has every hydrogen replaced with fluorine.
"Perfluoroaryl" refers to an aryl group which has every hydrogen replaced with fluorine. "Perfluoroaryl alkyl" refers an aralkyl group in which every hydrogen on the aryl moiety is replaced with fluorine.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable salt" includes salts of the compounds of the present invention derived from the combination of such compounds and an organic or inorganic acid. In practice the use of the salt form amounts to use of the base form. The compounds of the present invention are useful in both free base and salt form, with both forms being considered as being within the scope of the present invention. The term "Arg-al" refers to the residue of L-argininal which has the formula:
Figure imgf000027_0001
The .term "Arg-ol" refers to the residue of L-argininol which has the formula:
Figure imgf000028_0001
" (1) -N9-nitroargininol hydrochloride" refers to the compound which has the formula:
HCI - H,N. OH
^
NH H2N^N-N02
"N-alpha-t-butoxycarbonyl-N^-nitro-L-arginine" refers to the compound which has the formula:
Figure imgf000028_0002
"Bn" refers to benzyl.
"Boc" refers to t-buto3qrcarbonyl .
"BzlS02" refers to benzylsulfonyl . "Cbz" or wCBz" refers to benzyloxycarbonyl.
"DCA" refers to dichloroacetic acid.
"DCC" refers to N,N' -dicyclohexylcarbodiimide.
"DMF" refers to N, N-dimethylformamide. "DMSO" refers to dimethyl sulfoxide. "DMAP" refers to 4-N,N-dimethylaminopyridine. "EDC" refers to l-ethyl-3- (3-dimethylamino- propyl) carbodiimide hydrochloride salt. "Et3N" refers to triethylamine.
"EtOH" refers to ethanol.
"HBTU" refers to 2- (lH-benzotriazol-1-yl) -1, 1, 3 , 3- tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate .
"HC1" refers to hydrochloric acid. "HOAc" refers to acetic acid.
"HPLC" refers to high pressure liquid chromatography.
"HOBt" refers to 1-hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate.
"i-BuOCOCl" refers to isobutylchloroformate.
"LiAlH4" refers to lithium aluminum hydride. "LiAlH2 (OEt)2 refers to lithium aluminum dihydride diethoxide.
"Me" refers to methyl.
"NMM" refers to N-methylmorpholine .
"PhB(0H)2" refers to phenylboronic acid. "THF" refers to tetrahydrofuran.
"TLC" refers to thin layer chromatography.
Brief Description of the Drawings
Figure 1 provides a synthetic scheme for compound 11, which is further detailed in Examples 1 to 11. In this figure, the steps are defined as follows: In the synthesis of (2) from 6-amino-m-cresol : 1. phthalic anhydride, acetic acid, reflux to give a 95% yield of (1), N- (2-hydroxy-4- methylphenyDphthalimide) ; and 2. allyl bromide, K2C03, acetonitrile, reflux to give 97% yield of (2) . In the synthesis of (3) from (2): N,N-dimethylaniline, 185*C, about two hours, to give a 95% yield of (3) . In the synthesis of (5) from (3): 1. benzylbromide, K2C03, acetonitrile, reflux to give an 81% yield of (4), the benzyl ether derivative of (3); and 2. hydrazine, ethanol, reflux to give a 97% yield of (5) . In the synthesis of (6) from (5) : α-toluene sulfonyl chloride, 4-methylmorpholine, acetonitrile, temperature 0*C, then warming to room temperature to give 99% yield of (6) .
In the synthesis of (8) from (6): 1. ozone gas, methanol, - 78"C; 2. dimethylsulfide, -78*C, then warming to room temperature; 3. IN HCl, acetone, room temperature then reflux to give an intermediate phenylacetaldehyde derivative (7) ; and 4. Jones' oxidation, acetone, O'C, then warming to room temperature to give approximately quantitative yield of (8.) . In the synthesis of (10) from (8): 1. hydrochloride salt of
N^-nitro-L-argininal ethyl cyclol, EDC, 1- hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, N,N-diisopropylethylamine, acetonitrile, to give a 69% yield of (9); and 2. H2, Pd/C catalyst, 55 PSI, ethanol, acetic acid, water to give a 89% yield of (10). In the synthesis of (11) from (10): 1. 5N HCIO4, O'C, 60 minutes; and 2. HPLC, to give a 62% yield of
(11) •
Figure 2 provides a synthetic scheme for compound 19, which is further detailed in Examples 12 to 14. In this figure, the steps are defined as follows. In the synthesis of (2) from 6-amino-M-cresol: 1. phthalic anhydride, acetic acid, reflux, to give a 95% yield of (1); and 2. allyl bromide, K2C03, acetonitrile, reflux to give a 97% yield of
(2) . In the synthesis of (3) from (2) . N,N-dimethylaniline, 185 *C, about two hours, to give a 95% yield of (3) . In the synthesis of (13) from (3) : 1. iodomethane, K2CO3, acetonitrile, reflux, to give an 81% yield of (12); and 2. hydrazine, ethanol, reflux, to give a 90% yield of (13) . In the synthesis of (14) from (13) : α-toluene sulfonyl chloride, 4-methylmorpholine, acetonitrile, temperature 0*C, then warming to room temperature, to give approximately quantitative yield of (14) . In the synthesis of (16) from (14): 1. ozone gas, methanol, -78*C; 2. dimethylsulfide -78 "C, then warming to room temperature, to give an intermediate phenylacetaldehyde (15); and 3. Jones' oxidation, acetone, O'C, then warming to room temperature, to give a 46% overall yield of (16) . In the synthesis of (18) from (16) : 1. hydrochloride salt of N^-nitro-L-argininal ethyl cyclol, EDC, HOBt, N,N-diisopropylethylamine acetonitrile, to give a 62% yield of (17); and 2. H2, Pd/C catalyst, 55 PSI, ethanol, acetic acid, water, to give a 65% yield of (18) . In the synthesis of (19) from (18): 1. 3N HCl, room temperature; and 2. HPLC, to give a 74%, yield of (19) •
Figure 3 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of an intermediate used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) . In this figure, "i" through "vi" are defined as: i) thionyl chloride, methanol; ii) di-tert-butyl dicarbonate, pH 7-8; iii) hydrogen gas, platinum oxide in ethanol, water and acetic acid; iv) bis- benzyloxycarbonyl S-methylisothiourea, base, tetrahydrofuran; v) calcium chloride, sodium borohydride in tetrahydrofuran and ethanol; vi) HCl (anhydrous) . "*" indicates the position of an asymmetric carbon atom.
Figures 4 and 5 depict preferred reaction schemes for synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) . In these figures, "i" through "iii" are defined as: i) HOBt, EDC, dimethylaminopyridine, triethyla ine; ii) hydrogen gas, 10% palladium on charcoal and iii) dimethylsulfoxide, toluene, dichloroacetic acid and EDC. Figure 6 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of an intermediate used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) . In this figure, "i" through "xvi" are defined as: (i) potassium iodide, dioxane; (ii) 2.5 M sodium ethoxide in ethanol, argon atmosphere; reflux 6 hours; (iii) yield after workup 60%; (iv) pyridine, triethylamine; (v) H2S(g), stirred at room temperature 16 hours; yield after workup 98%; (vi) acetone, iodomethane, reflux 30 minutes, filtration, methanol; (vii) ammonium acetate, reflux 1 hour, filter and dry; (viii) concentrated HCl, reflux 3 hours, yield after workup 30%; (ix) dioxane, sodium bicarbonate, di- t-butyl dicarbonate, stir 18 hours at room temperature; (x) 4°C, 4.0 N NaOH to pH 12; 4-methoxy-2, 3, 6- trimethylbenzenesulfonyl chloride in dioxane; (xi) 1.0 N HC1- to pH 7-8, water, yield after workup 68%; (xii) 0,N-dimethyl hydroxylamine hydrochloride, hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, 4- methylmorpholine, THF, -stir 2 hours, yield after workup 69%; (xiii) LiAlH4, THF, dry ice/acetone bath; (xiv) aqueous potassium bisulfate, yield after workup 86%; (xv) 4- Benzhydrylsemicarbizide trifluoroacetate salt (the compound of Example 23), sodium acetate trihydrate in ethanol, reflux, yield after workup 89%; and (xvi) 50% TFA/DCM, add to ether, yield after workup 79%.
Figure 7 depicts a preferred reaction scheme for synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) . In this figure, "i" through "iii" are defined as: (i) EDC, hydroxybenzotriazole, 4-methyl-morpholine in DMF; (ii) HF/anisole (9:1), aqueous acetic acid; and (iii) methanol, 1% HF (aqueous) , formalin.
Figure 8 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) which incorporates an arginine chloromethylketone moiety at PI. In this figure, "i" through "iii" are defined as: (i) EDC, HOBt, NMM, CH3CN, room temperature; (iia) i-BuOCOCl, NMM, DMF at -20°C; (iib) add 45 DMF, Et3N, allow temperature to increase from -20° to room temperature; and (iii) HF, anisole.
Figure 9 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) which incorporates an argimine ketoamide moiety at PI. In this figure, "i" through "iii" are defined as: (i) EDC, HOBt, NMM, CH3CN, room temperature; (ii) H2, palladium on carbon, EtOH, H20, HOAc to give intermediate 50; and (iii) EDC, DMSO, DCAA, toluene, temperature is allowed to increase from 0° to room temperature.
Figure 10 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) having a boronic acid moiety at PI. In this figure, "i" through "vii" are defined as: (i) treatment of 16 with iBuCOCl, NMM, THF, at -20°C; (ii) addition of 52, CHC13 ; (iii) Et3N, at -20°C; (iv) NaN3 ; DMF, at temperature of 80 to 100°C to give intermediate azide 54; (v) H , Pd(0H ) /carbon, methanol, HCl; (vi) formamidine sulfonic acid (H2NC1=NH) S03H, DMAP, EtOH, reflux, to give intermediate 56; and (vii) PhB(OH)2, Et20, H 0.
Figure 11 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of a compound of formula (II) having a C^ to C4 perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone moiety at PI. In this figure, "i" to "vi" are defined as: (i) EDC, HOBt, NMM, CH3CN, at room temperature; (ii) i-BuOCOCl, NMM, DMF, temperature about -30°C to -15°C to room temperature; (iii) TFA, CH2C12, temperature about 0°C to room temperature to give intermediate 60; (iv) bis-Cbz-S-methyl isothiourea (CbzNHC(=NCbz) SMe) , THF, Et3N; (v) Swern oxidation with mixture of oxalylchloride, DMSO, Et N, CH2C13, temperature at about -78°C to room temperature, to give ketone intermediate 62; and (vi) HF, anisole, temperature at about -78°C to room temperature. Figure 12 depicts the reaction scheme for preparation of intermediate 69 which is used for the synthesis of certain compounds of formula (I) . In this figure "i" through "vi" are defined as: i) thionyl chloride, methanol; ii) di-tert- butyl carbonate, pH 7-8; iii) hydrogen gas, platinum oxide in ethanol, water and acetic acid; iv) bis-benzyloxycarbonyl 5- methylisQthiourea, base, tetrahydrofuran; v) calcium chloride, sodium borohydride in tetrahydrofurin and ethanol; vi) HCl (anhydrous) . "*" indicates the position of an assymetric carbon atom.
Detailed Description of the Invention
1 . Preferred Novel Compounds
Novel compounds of the present invention include compounds of the Formula (I) :
Figure imgf000034_0001
wherein
(a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S (0) 2- ,
-N (R ' ) -S (0) 2- , -C (=0) - , -OC (=0) - , -NH-C (=0) - , -P (0) (R" ) - and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is NHR' , OR' , R' , or SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
(1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Cl to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R' ,
(3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Cl to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
(4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and. which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R'.
(5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl or alkoxy, or -CO2R', (6) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' . (7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, respectively,
(8) heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and
S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2. and/or Y3,
(9) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2. and/or Y3,
(10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(11) aralkenyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2. and/or Y3,
Figure imgf000036_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaralkyl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,
(19) perfluoroaralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and
(21)
Figure imgf000036_0002
is a 5 to 7 membered heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is -CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2- or -S-, and wherein Yi, Y2, and Y3 are
(i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, -CH(CF3)2_ -C (OH) (CF3) 2, -OCF3,
-OCF2CF3, -0C(0)NH2, -0C(0)NHZi, -OC(0)NZιZ2, -NHC(0)Zι, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NHZl, -NHC (0)NZlZ2 , -C(0)OH, C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZl, -C(0)NZlZ2, -C^OZ^ -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)OH, -P(0)3(Zl)2, -S(0)3H , -S(0)mZ1/ -Zlf -OZ1# -OH, -NH2, -NH^i, and -NZχZ2, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, and 2,^ and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]g0-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms; (c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms;
(d) R3 is selected from the group consisting of
Figure imgf000037_0001
where d is an integer from 0 to 5 and W is -N- or -CH-; (e) R4 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl, wherein n is 0, 1 or 2 , and. Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is
— N v not a camphor derivative or ^ — ' heterocycle ,
(ii ) -CF3 , -CF2H, -OCF3 , -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen, (iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with
Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -ORs, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR8 and -S(0)pR8, wherein Rs is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms., and p is 0, 1 or 2, (v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, (viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms are heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(ix) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(f) R5 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ Rl is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor derivative
—N v or V—_ heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, or -OCF2H, and
(iii) halogen;
(g) R6 is selected from the group consisting of (i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, ~S(0)nRl« wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor .
—N v derivative or — ' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, or -OCF2H, (iii) halogen, (iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Zδ, wherein Zδ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHR9. -C(0)0H, -C(0)0Rg, and -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms including 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and p is 0, 1 or 2;
(v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms; (vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, (viii) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of 6 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3 , and
(x) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; and
(h) R7 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above with the-
—N v proviso that Ri is not a camphor derivative or *^S heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3,or -CF2H,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10* -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll,
(v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR 0, -Cθ2Rl0# -Sθ2RlO θr -CONRioRll,
(vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -Sθ2Rl0 θr -CONRioRll, and
(vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10. -Cθ2 lO# -SO2R10, -CONRioRll, and wherein each Rio and Rn is independently selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen; or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
Preferred X groups include a direct link, -SO2-, and -NH-S(0)2~. An especially preferred X group is -SO2-. Preferred Ri groups include alkyl, aralkyl, and aryl groups. Preferred aryl groups include substituted or unsubstituted phenyl and naphthyl, 2, 3-methylenedioxyphenyl, and 3, 4-methylenedioxyphenyl. Preferred substitutions include, methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, and -OCF3. Meta and ortho ring substitutions are preferred.
Meta and ortho di-substitutions on the ring are also preferred.
Particularly preferred Ri groups include aralkyl groups. Especially preferred Ri groups include substituted or unsubstituted benzyl and naphthylalkyl groups. Cyclohexyl and cyclohexylmethyl are also especially preferred Ri groups. A particularly preferred R2 group is hydrogen. Preferred R3 groups include
Figure imgf000041_0001
and
Preferred R4 groups include: (i) hydrogen,
(ii) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -0R8, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)0H, -C(0)OR8 and -S(0)pR8;
(iii) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cyclic alkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms, (v) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 7 carbon atoms,
(vi) heteroaryl having 1 to about 4 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms are heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
(vii) heteroaralkyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms having 1 to about 4 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms are heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and . (viii) trifluoromethyl. Preferred R4 groups also include methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, R-sec-butyl, S-sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, R-2-pentyl, S-2-pentyl, 3-pentyl, S-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, R-2- (3-methyl) -butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, R-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-hexyl, S-2-hexyl, R-2-hexyl, R-3-hexyl, S-3-hexyl, hydroxy, lower alkoxy of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, phenyloxy, -OCF3, and halogen. Preferred R5 groups include hydrogen, halogen, alkyl of 1 to about 5 carbon atoms, trifluoromethyl, and alkoxy of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms. Hydrogen is an especially preferred R5 group.
Preferred R6 groups include: (i) hydrogen,
(ii) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Zζ , wherein Z6 is as defined above,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms,
(iv) alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, (v) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(vi) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and having the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(vii) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and
(viii) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and having the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
More preferred Rβ groups, when R4 and R5 are independently hydrogen or methyl, are selected from the group consisting of aralkyl of about 8 to about 13 carbon atoms, -O-Ri, -NH-Rτ_, and -S(0)pRι wherein Ri is preferably aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms. Preferred aryl components of the aralkyl groups include unsubstituted and substituted phenyl or naphthyl groups. Preferred substitutions on the aryl ring include methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, alkoxycarbonyl, methylenedioxy and amidocarbonyl . Phenylethyl, phenylpropyl , cyclohexylethyl and cyclohexylpropyl are especially preferred R6 groups . Especially preferred R7 groups include hydrogen, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl. Hydrogen and methyl are especially preferred R7 groups. Preferred R7 groups also include those selected from the group consisting of: (i) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -S02Rl0 θr -CONRioRjLl,
(ii) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10. -Sθ2RlO θr -CONRioRll,
(iii) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10, -Sθ2 lθ θr -CONRioRll,
(iv) aryl and heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10, -SO2R1O or -CONRioRll/ and . (v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10, -Sθ2Rl0/θr -CONRioRll- A particularly preferred embodiment is when R5 and Rg are independently selected to be hydrogen or methyl, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, R-sec- butyl, S-sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, R-2-pentyl, S-2- pentyl, 3-pentyl, S-1- (2-methyl) -butyl, R-2- (3-methyl) -butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, R-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 2- pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-hexyl, S-2-hexyl, R-2-hexyl, R-3- hexyl, and S-3-hexyl. A particularly preferred embodiment according to this aspect includes compounds where R4 is hydrogen or methyl.
According to a particularly preferred aspect, provided are compounds of formula I wherein X is -S(0)2-/ Rl is substituted or unsubstituted aralkyl, and R3 is
Figure imgf000044_0001
A very preferred aspect is directed to such compounds where Rl is substituted or unsubstituted benzyl.
According to another preferred aspect, provided are compounds of formula I, wherein any two of R2, R4, R5, and Rg are hydrogen.
Particulary preferred compounds according to this invention include N- [2-hydroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyl]-L-argininal (Example 11) and N-[2- methoxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6-methylphenylacetyl] -L- argininal (Example 14) .
According to another aspect, the present invention is directed to compounds having inhibitory activity toward proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class. Crystal structures of serine protease inhibitors in complex with their cognate enzymes have been determined and are available from the Brookhaven National Laboratory Protein Data Bank. The three-dimensional crystal structures of proteases of the trypsin/chymotrypsin class are highly conserved within the class. The most potent inhibitors in the class make specific hydrogen bonds with structurally conserved backbone atoms of amino acid 216 of the protease (using the standard chymotrypsin numbering system) . In most inhibitors, these hydrogen bonds are formed by atoms of peptide amide bonds or sulfonamide bonds. Thus, this aspect of the invention is directed to compounds of formula (II) :
Figure imgf000045_0001
wherein a substituted phenol or phenyl ether is present in the compound in place of the amide bond of an inhibitor that makes hydrogen bonds to amino acid 216 in the trypsin/chymotrypsin class of serine proteases. Thus, according to this aspect of the present invention, provided are compounds of formula (II), wherein X, Ri, R2, R4, R5, Rg, and R7 are as defined hereinabove in connection with formula
(I) , and
(a) R12 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms optionally substituted with amino, amidino, or guanidino,
(ii) aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino,
(iii) aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino, and
(iv) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having about 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino; and
(b) TS is selected from the group consisting of (i) -CHO, (ii) -C(0)CF3,
(iii) -C(0)CF2CF3,
(iv) -C(0)-C(0)-NHR13,
(v) -C(0)-C(0)2R13,
(vi) -C(0)-C(0)-NR13R14, (vii) -B(OR13) (OR14),
(viii) -C(0)CH2C1, and
(ix) -C(0)R15; wherein R13 and R14 are independently selected from hydrogen lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur, and R-L5 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms and heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur. In the case where TS is (vii) , additionally -0R;L3 and -OR^4 may be taken together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]qO- wherein Z3, Z4 and q are as defined in connection with formula (I) . Also included are pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of formula (II) .
According to a preferred aspect, inhibitors of elastase will have a small alkyl group, such as methyl, for R.._.
Inhibitors of chymotrypsin preferably will have an aralkyl group, such as benzyl, for R12 according to formula (II) .
Serine protease inhibitors that have a basic amino acid in the primary specificity site, such as inhibitors of trypsin, thrombin, factor Xa, factor Vila, will have an amino, amidino, or guanidino substituted alkyl, aryl, or aralkyl group for R12 •
According to another aspect, the present invention includes within its scope salts of the compounds of formulas I and II. These salts include salts of the compounds of the present invention derived from the combination of such compounds and an organic or inorganic acid. In practice, the use of the salt form may amount to use of the (free) base form. The compounds of the present invention are useful in both free base and salt form, with both forms being considered as being within the scope of the present invention. These salts include acid addition salts, for example, salts of hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, acetic acid, benzene sulfonic acid and other suitable acid addition salts including maleate, fumarate and citrate salts .
2. Preparation of Preferred Compounds Figures 1 and 2 depict synthetic schemes for two preferred compounds according to this invention. Figure 1 outlines a sequence of reactions for the preparation of a preferred species of the present invention. Commercially available 6-amino-m-cresol is reacted with phthalic anhydride, optionally in the presence of an inert solvent like acetic acid, toluene, or xylene, at about 100-150°C to afford the phthalimide intermediate 1. Reaction of 1 with allyl bromide in the presence of a suitable base such as anhydrous potassium carbonate in an inert solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at a temperature in the range from about room temperature to about 110°C provides the allyl ether derivative intermediate 2. Thermal Claisen rearrangement of 2, performed either neat or optionally in a suitable inert solvent such as N,N-dimethylaniline, at about 150-250°C gives the allylphenol 3. Reaction of phenol derivative 3 with benzyl bromide in an inert solvent such as N, N- dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at about room temperature to about 110°C provides the benzyl ether derivative 4. Cleavage of the phthalimido moiety of 4 is achieved selectively utilizing hydrazine in an alcoholic solvent such as ethanol at a temperature from about 20 to 80°C and affords the aniline derivative 5. Coupling of 5 with a suitable sulfonyl chloride such as benzylsulfonyl chloride in an inert solvent such as N, N-dimethylformamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at a temperature of about - 10°C to about 50°C in the presence of a base such as pyridine, collidine, triethylamine, N,N- diisopropylethylamine, or N-methylmorpholine gives the benzylsulfonamide derivative 6. Treatment of a solution of 6 in solvent, preferably methanol, ethanol, ethyl acetate, acetone or methylene chloride, or mixtures of the preceding solvents, with a stream of ozone gas at a temperature of about -80°C to about 0°C, followed by reductive decomposition of the ozonide in situ with reagents such as dimethyl sulfide, triethyl phosphite, triphenylphosphine, triethylamine, or zinc metal generates an aldehyde intermediate 7. When alcoholic solvents such as methanol are utilized, the reaction affords a mixture of the desired aldehyde along with varying amounts of the corresponding dimethyl acetal derivative. These mixtures are dissolved in a inert solvent such as acetone and hydrolyzed with dilute mineral acids such as 1 N hydrochloric acid at about room temperature to about reflux temperature which quantitatively affords the desired aldehyde 7. Oxidation of aldehyde substrate 7 with reagents such as pyridinium dichromate in N, N-dimethylformamide or chromic acid in acetone at a temperature of about 0°C to 30°C gives the carboxylic acid derivative 8 . Compound 8 is coupled to N9-nitro-L-argininal ethyl cyclol using 1-hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate, 1- ethyl-3- ( 3 -dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide hydrochloride salt , and then N, N-diisopropylamine to give 9 . The N^-nitro group of 9 is removed by treatment with hydrogen gas and palladium on carbon in ethanol, water, and acetic acid at about 20 to 60 psi . This reaction produces acetate acid sal 10 . The ethyl cyclol group of 10 is hydrolyzed by treatment with a suitable acid catalyst such as dilute hydrochloric acid, sulfuric acid, methanesulfonic acid, perchloric acid or hexaf luorophoshoric acid followed by HPLC purification with 0 . 1% trif luoroacetic acid in acetonitrile and water to produce the product 11.
The reaction scheme of Figure 2 depicts the preparation of another very preferred compound. It differs from the synthetic scheme of Figure 1 in that intermediate 3 is first reacted with methyl iodide in the presence of a suitable base such as anhydrous potassium carbonate in an inert solvent such as N, N- dimethyl formamide, dioxane, tetrahydrofuran, or acetonitrile at a temperature of about room temperature to about 110°C , to provide the methyl ether derivative 12 . Intermediate 12 is processed through an analogous set of reactions to those outlined in Figure 1 to produce the target argininal derivative 19.
The preferred means of chemically coupling (as for example , intermediate 8 to argininal ethyl cyclol to give intermediate 9 as depicted in Figure 1) include formation of a peptide bond using conventional coupling reagents known in the art . See Bodanszky, N. , Peptide Chemistry, pp . 55-73 , Springer-Verlag, New York (1988) and references cited therein . The chemical coupling may be either by means of one-step or two-step coupling. In one-step coupling, the two coupling partners are coupled directly. Preferred coupling reagents for one-step coupling include DCC with HOBt, EDC with HOBt,. BOP, HBTU or TBTU. In two-step coupling, an activated ester or anhydride of the C-terminal carboxy group of one coupling partner is formed prior to its coupling to the other coupling partner. For compounds of the present invention containing alkenyl or aryl moieties substituted with halogen, cyano, nitro, or -S-Zi, it is preferred to avoid the use of hydrogen gas with palladium on carbon for cleaving the N9-nitro protecting group on the arginine s de chain. Instead, it is preferred to use boron tris (trifluoroacetate) , B(OCOCF3)3, to cleave the N^-nitro of the arginine group. This reagent may be prepared by the reaction of BBr3 and CF3COOH in dichloromethane at 0°C. Alternatively, the reagent is also commercially available. Generally, the N^-nitro compound is treated with boron tris (trifluoroacetate) in trifluoroacetic acid at 0°C. See, e. g. , Fieser, M. and Fieser, L. F., Reagents for Organic Synthesis, p. 46, John Wiley & Sons, New York (1974); and Pless, J., and Bauer, W. Angew. Chem.. Internet. Ed.. 12, 147 (1973). Another preferred reagent for selective nitro group cleavage is titanium trichloride. 'This reagent is commercially available. The N^-nitro compound is treated with titanium trichloride in aqueous methanol containing an ammonium acetate buffer followed by exposure of the reaction mixture to air or dimethyl sulfoxide. See, e. g. , Freidinger, R.M. , Hirschmann, R. , and Veber, D.F., J. Pro. Chem.. 43, 4800 (1978).
Another preferred method for synthesizing these compounds having an L-argininal moiety is to use the di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl protecting group for the L-argininal moiety for groups incompatible with hydrogenation with palladium on carbon. For example, alpha-N-benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega' -di-N-t-butoxycarbonylarginine is dissolved in acetonitrile and treated with hydroxybenzotriazole and 1- ethyl-3-(3-dimethylamino-propyl)carbodiimide HCl salt to form alpha-N-benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega ' -di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl-L-arginine lactam. The lactam is reduced by treatment with LiAlH4 in THF at -70°C to provide alpha-N- benzyloxycarbonyl-omega, omega '-di-N-t-butoxycarbonyl-L- argininal. This aldehyde is protected as the diethyl acetal by treatment with ethanol and HCl. The N-benzyloxycarbonyl protecting group is removed by treatment with hydrogen gas and palladium on carbon to give omega, omega' -di-N-t- butoxycarbonyl-L-argininal diethyl acetal, HCl salt. This, protected L-argininal moiety can then be coupled to a desired carboxylic acid by treatment with N-hydro^benzotriazole and l-ethyl-3- (3-dimethylamino-propyl) carbodiimide HCl salt. The diethyl acetal and the di-Boc protecting groups are removed by treatment with hexafluorophosphoric acid in acetonitrile at 0°C. The reaction mixture is quenched by addition of 2.5 M aqueous sodium acetate until pH 4 is reached. The mixture is filtered through a 2 micron filter. Preparative HPLC using 0.1% CF3COOH in 10-40% aqueous acetonitrile provides the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired substituted L- argininal compound. Figure 3 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 25 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) according to reaction schemes depicted in Figures 4 and 5. Examples 15 to 19 describe preparation of 25 in further detail. Figures 4 and 5 depict reaction schemes for the preparation of certain compounds of formula (I) wherein R is a 3-piperidinyl-(N-guanidino) group. Preparation of compound 28 is described in further detail in Examples 20 to 22. Compound 31 is prepared using the appropriate reagents according to procedures similar to those described in Examples 20 to 22.
Figure 6 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of intermediate 41 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) according to the reaction scheme depicted in Figure 7. Examples 24 to 30 describe the preparation of 41 in further detail.
Intermediates used in the preparation of compounds of formula (I) having a 4-amidinophenylalaninal group at PI may be prepared according to the reaction scheme depicted in Figure 6 and described in Examples 24 to 30, using the appropriate alpha-bromo-para-tolunitrile starting material .
Figure 7 depicts a reaction scheme for preparation of a compound of formula (I) wherein R is 3-amidinophenyl.
Preparation of 44 is more fully described in Examples 31 to 33.
Figure 12 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 69 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) . Intermediate 69 is prepared by procedures similar to those described in Examples 15 to 19 and using the appropriate starting materials. Intermediate
69 may be coupled to intermediates such as 8 and 16 according to reaction schemes analogous to those depicted in Figures 4 and 5.
Compounds of formula (II) may be prepared by methods such as described hereinbelow:
Figure 8 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-arginine chloromethylketone moiety. Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known arginine chloromethylketone precursor 45 (Kettner, C. and Shaw, E., Biochemistry, 17: 4778 (1978); Kettner, C. and Shaw, E., Biochim. Biophys . Acta, 569: 31 (1979)) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate and NMM at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 46.
Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile or DMF. Double deprotection of intermediate 46 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at a temperature in the range of about -78°C to about room temperature gives the desired product 47.
Figure 9 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-ketoargininamide moiety. Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known hydroxyargininamide precursor 48 (see, e.g. commonly assigned U.S. Patent Nos. 5,371,072 and 5,597,804) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate, and NMM at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 49. Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile or DMF. Deprotection of intermediate 49 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at about -78°C to about room temperature, or by catalytic hydrogenation using a suitable catalyst such as Pd/C or Pd(OH)2/C in a solvent composed of ethanol, water and/or acetic acid gives the intermediate 50. Finally, oxidation of intermediate 50 under the standard Moffatt conditions with EDC, DMSO and dichloroacetic acid in a suitable solvent such as toluene at about -10°C to room temperature produces the desired product
51.
Figure 10 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-boronic acid moiety. Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known protected boroarginine ester precursor 52 (See, e. g. , Wityak, J. et. al., J. Ore. Chem.. 60: 3717 (1995) and references cited therein) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate, NMM and then in situ added Et3N at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 53. Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile, dichloromethane, chloroform, DMF, or mixtures thereof. Reaction of intermediate 53 with sodium azide in a suitable inert solvent such as DMF, N, N-dimethylacetamide, DMSO or l-methyl-2- pyrrolidinone at about room temperature to about 100°C affords the azide 54. Catalytic hydrogenation of intermediate azide 54 in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol preferably in the presence of hydrogen chloride gives the intermediate amine salt 55. Reaction of intermediate 55 with formamidine sulfonic acid in an alcoholic solvent such as ethanol preferably in the presence of a tertiary amine, especially
DMAP, at about room temperature to 100°C produces intermediate
56. Deprotection of intermediate 56 by an exchange reaction preferably with phenylboronic acid in a two-phase solvent system such as ether and water then gives the desired boronic acid product 57.
Figure 11 outlines a synthetic sequence for the preparation of a preferred compound of the invention which incorporates a Pl-Cl to C4 perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone moiety. Coupling of carboxylic acid derivative 16 with the known perfluoroargininol precursor 58 (see, e. g. , Schacht,
A.L., Shuman, R.T., and Wiley, M.R., UK Patent Application GB 2287027 A, Sept. 6, 1995 and references cited therein; for the application of the Dakin-West protocol to arginine and related substrates, see also Ueda, T., Kam, CM., and Powers, J.C, Biochem. J.. 265: 539 (1990); Buchanan, G.L., Chem. Soc . Rev.. 17: 91 (1988)) under standard carbodiimide conditions of EDC, HOBt, and NMM at about 0°C to room temperature or under standard mixed anhydride conditions of isobutyl chloroformate, and NMM at about -30°C to room temperature affords intermediate 59. Suitable solvents for either reaction include THF, acetonitrile, dichloromethane, chloroform, DMF or mixtures thereof. Removal of the Boc protecting group is accomplished by treatment of 59 with an acid catalyst such as TFA, or hydrogen chloride in a suitable insert solvent such as dichloromethane, ethanol or ethyl acetate and produces intermediate 60. Reaction of 60 with a suitable optionally protected guanylating reagent such as bis-Cbz-S-methyl isothiourea in an inert solvent such as DMF or THF in the presence of a base such as triethylamine provides the protected intermediate 61. Swern oxidation of 61 with a mixture of oxalyl chloride, DMSO, triethylamine in dichloromethane at about -78°C to room temperature gives the ketone intermediate 62. Finally, deprotection of 62 with anhydrous hydrogen fluoride optionally in the presence of anisole at about -78°C to room temperature produces the desired perfluoroalkylargininyl ketone 63.
Figure 12 depicts a reaction scheme for the preparation of intermediate 69 which is used in the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) . Intermediate 69 may be coupled to intermediates such as 8 and 16 according to reaction schemes analogous to those depicted in Figures 4 and 5.
3. Selection of Preferred Compounds
The compounds of the present invention are screened for their ability to inhibit thrombin, plasmin, tissue plasminogen activator (t-PA) , activated protein C (aPC) , chymotrypsin, and trypsin as set forth below. Certain of the preferred compounds are distinguished by their ability to inhibit thrombin, while not substantially inhibiting plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin. With respect to thrombin and the other enzymes and as used herein, the term "not substantially inhibiting" means that the IC50 (or Kj.) for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and/or trypsin for a given compound is greater than or equal to its IC50 (or Ki, respectively) for thrombin. With respect to compounds within the present invention that inhibit members within the trypsin/chymotrypsin family, including trypsin, chymotrypsin, elastase, and serine proteases involved in the coagulation cascade, "not specifically inhibiting" means the IC50 or K for the target enzyme is less than or equal to the IC50 or KA for non-target enzymes contacted with the inhibitor.
For screening compounds using these assays, the compounds of the present invention are dissolved in buffer to give solutions containing concentrations such that assay concentrations range from 0 to 100 micromolar. In the assays for thrombin, plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin, a chromogenic synthetic substrate is added to a solution containing test compound and the enzyme of interest and the residual catalytic activity of that enzyme is determined spectrophometrically. The IC5Q of a compound of the present invention is determined from the rate of substrate turnover caused by the specific enzyme being measured. IC50 is the concentration of test compound which gives 50% inhibition of the rate of substrate turnover. Likewise, the Ki of a compound of the present invention is determined from the rate of substrate turnover caused by the specific enzyme being measured at various enzyme concentrations. Examples A, B and C provide an exemplars of in vitro assays used to select the compounds of the present invention.
Certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have a Ki of about 0.001 to about 200 nM in the thrombin assay. Especially preferred compounds have a K of about 0.001 to about 50 nM. The more especially preferred compounds have a Ki of about 0.001 to about 10 nM.
Certain of the preferred compounds of the present invention have a IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is at least 10 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin. Especially preferred compounds have an IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is about 20 to about 100,000 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin. More especially preferred compounds have an IC50 for plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, and trypsin which is about 100 to about 1,000,000 times greater than its IC50 for thrombin. In the event that a compound of the present invention has an IC50 with respect to plasmin, t-PA, aPC, chymotrypsin, or trypsin which is greater than the highest concentration of compound tested, the highest concentration of compound tested is considered to be the reported IC50.
4. Pharmaceutical Compositions
In another aspect, the present invention encompasses pharmaceutical compositions prepared for storage or administration which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
The "therapeutically effective amount" of a compound of the present invention will depend on the route of administration, the type of mammal being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific mammal under consideration. These factors and their relationship to determining this amount are well known to skilled practitioners in the medical arts. This amount and the method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which, as noted, those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
The "therapeutically effective amount" of the compound of the present invention can range broadly depending upon the desired affects and the therapeutic indication. Typically, dosages will be between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers" for therapeutic use are well known in the pharmaceutical art, and are described, for example, in Remington' s Pharmeceutical Sciences . Mack Publishing Co. (A.R. Gennaro edit. 1985) . For example, sterile saline and phosphate-buffered saline at physiological pH may be used. Preservatives, stabilizers, dyes and even flavoring agents may be provided in the pharmaceutical composition. For example, sodium benzoate, sorbic acid and esters of p-hydroxybenzoic acid may be added as preservatives . Id. at 1449. In addition, antioxidants and suspending agents may be used. Id.
The pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may be formulated and used as tablets, capsules or elixirs for oral administration; suppositories for rectal administration; sterile solutions and suspensions for injectable administration; and the like. The dose and method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
When administration is to be parenteral, such as intravenous on a daily basis, injectable pharmaceutcial compositions can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions. Suitable excipients are, for example, water, saline, dextrose, mannitol, lactose, lecithin, albumin, sodium glutamate, cysteine hydrochloride, or the like. In addition, if desired, the injectable pharmaceutical compositions may contain minor amounts of nontoxic auxilliary substances, such as wetting agents, pH buffering agents, and the like. If desired, absorption enhancing preparations (e.g., liposomes) may be utilized.
5. Utility.
Certain compounds of the present invention when made and selected as disclosed are useful as potent inhibitors of thrombin in vitro and in vivo. As such, these compounds are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents to prevent the clotting of blood and as in vivo pharmaceutical agents to prevent thrombosis in mammals suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis. The compounds of the present invention are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents for inhibiting clotting in blood drawing tubes . The use of stoppered test tubes having a vaccum therein as a means to draw blood obtained by venipuncture into the tube is well known in the medical arts . See, e . g. , Kasten, B.L., "Specimen Collection", Laboratory Test Handbook. 2nd Edition, Lexi-Comp Inc., Cleveland pp. 16- 17 (Edits. Jacobs, D.S. et al. 1990). Such vacuum tubes may be free of clot-inhibiting additives, in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian serum from the blood. They may alternatively contain clot-inhibiting additives (such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts), in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian plasma from the blood. The compounds of the present invention are potent inhibitors of blood clotting enzymes, such as factor Xa or thrombin, and as such, can be incorporated into blood collection tubes to prevent clotting of the mammalian blood drawn into them.
The compounds of the present invention are used alone, in combination of other compounds of the present invention, or in combination with other known inhibitors of clotting, in the blood collection tubes . The amount to be added to such tubes is that amount sufficient to inhibit the formation of a clot when mammalian blood is drawn into the tube. The addition of the compounds to such tubes may be accomplished by methods well known in the art, such as by introduction of a liquid composition thereof, as a solid coπposition thereof, or liquid composition which is lyophilized to a solid. The compounds of the present invention are added to blood collection tubes in such amounts that, when combined with 2 to 10 mL of mammalian blood, the concentration of such compounds will be sufficient to inhibit clot formation. Typically, the required concentration will be about 1 to 10,000 nM, with 10 to 1000 nM being preferred.
Certain of the compounds of the present invention are useful as a pharmaceutical agent for preventing thrombosis in a mammal suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis . Conditions characterized by abnormal thrombosis are well known in the medical arts and include those involving the arterial and venous vasculature of mammals. With respect to the coronary arterial vasculature, abnormal thrombosis (thrombus formation) characterizes the rupture of an established atherosclerotic plaque which is the major cause of acute myocardial infarction and unstable angina, as well as also characterizing the occlusive coronary thrombus formation resulting from either thrombolytic therapy or percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty (PTCA) . With respect to the venous vasculature, abnormal thrombosis characterizes the condition observed in patients undergoing major surgery in the lower extremities or the abdominal area who often suffer from thrombus formation in the venous vasculature resulting in reduced blood flow to the affected extremity and a predisposition to pulmonary embolism. Abnormal thrombosis further characterizes disseminated intravascular coagulopathy which commonly occurs within both vascular systems during septic shock, certain viral infections and cancer, a condition wherein there is rapid consumption of coagulation factors and systemic coagulation which results in the formation of life- threatening thrombi occurring throughout the microvasculature leading to widespread organ failure.
The present invention includes methods for preventing a condition in a mammal suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis, comprising administering to said mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or a pharmaceutical coπposition of the present invention. The compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention are administered in vivo, ordinarily in a mammal, preferably in a human. In employing them in vivo, the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions can be administered to a mammal in a variety of ways, including orally, parenterally, intravenously, subcutaneously, intramuscularly, colonically, rectally, nasally or intraperitoneally, employing a variety of dosage forms . Administration is preferably parenteral, such as intravenous on a daily basis. Alternatively, administration is preferably oral, such as by. tablets, capsules or elixers taken on a daily basis. In practicing the methods of the present invention, the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention are administered alone or in combination with one another, or in combination with other therapeutic or in vivo diagnostic agents. As is apparent to one skilled in the medical art, a therapeutically effective amount of the compounds or pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention will vary depending upon the age, weight and mammalian species treated, the particular compounds employed, the particular mode of administration and the desired affects and the therapeutic indication. Because these factors and their relationship to determining this amount are well known in the medical arts, the determination of therapeutically effective dosage levels, the amount necessary to achieve the desired result of preventing thrombosis, wiil be within the ambit of one skilled in these arts. Typically, administration of the compounds or pharmaceutical composition of the present invention is commenced at lower dosage levels, with dosage levels being increased until the desired effect of preventing in vivo thrombosis is achieved which would define a therapeutically effective amount. For the compounds of the present invention, alone or as part of a pharmaceutical coπposition, such doses are between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight. Certain compounds of the present invention have utility as inhibitors of proteases within the trypsin/chymotrypsin class of enzymes. Members of that class include, but are not limited to, elastase, chymotrypsin, and the serine proteases trypsin, thrombin, factor Xa, and factor Vila. With respect to the inhibitors within the present invention directed at serine proteases acting within the coagulation cascade, e. g. inhibitors of thrombin, factor Xa and factor Vila, such have in vi tro and in vivo utilities as provided hereinabove for thrombin inhibitors .
Elastase has been implicated in a variety of conditions, including pulmonary hypertension (Rabinovitch, M. , Acta Paediatr. Jpn 37:657-666 (1995)), idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis, rheumatoid arthritis, adult respiratory distress syndrome, cystic fibrosis, and other inflammatory diseases and conditions (Doring, G., Am. J. Respir. Crit. Care Med. 150:S114-S117 (1994)). Inhibition of elastase was shown to prevent or retard progression of pulmonary hypertension (Rabinovitch) . Thus, inhibitors of the present invention directed toward elastase are useful as pharmaceutical compositions for the inhibition of elastase in conditions where elastase activity is associated with a pathological condition.
Elevated levels of chymotrypsin and trypsin are associated with the pathological effects resulting from pancreatitis (see US 5,534,498). Animal studies of chemically- induced pancreatitis suggest that the disorder is rooted in the inability of pancreatic acinar cells to excrete digestive proenzymes, resulting in activation of trypsinogen to trypsin by lysosomal hydrolases within the cell. The amount of trypsin produced exceeds protective levels of protease inhibitor normally available.
The elevated levels of trypsin then cause activation of the other digestive enzymes co-localized with trypsin in the lysosome, such as chymotrypsin. The net effect of the enzyme activation is pancreatitis, which is characterized by damage to the pancreas and surrounding tissues from autodigestion of the cells by the various digestive enzymes. These activated digestive enzymes also cause edema, interstitial hemorrhage, vascular damage, coagulation necrosis, fat necrosis and parenchymal cell necrosis. Inhibitors of the present invention directed toward either trypsin or chymotrypsin, or.ther members of the trypsin/chymotrypsin family that contribute to the deleterious effects of pancreatitis, are useful for the prevention and treatment of pancreatitis in mammals.
In addition to the in vivo utilities, inhibitors of the present invention also find utility in vitro. Inhibitors of enzymes within the coagulation cascade are useful inhibitors of blood coagulation in vitro, as described hereinabove. Inhibitors of other enzymes within the trypsin/chymotrypsin family, including trypsin, chymotrypsin, and elastase, are' useful reagents in in vi tro assays designed to measure the activity of such enzymes .
For instance, to determine or confirm the presence of active trypsin, chymotrypsin, or elastase in a sample, the activity of the enzyme in the sample is determined in the presence and absence of the specific inhibitor (which may be labeled using a radioactive or other detectable label) . Lower activity measured in the presence of inhibitor as compared to in the absence of inhibitor demonstrates inhibition of the enzyme and, thus, its presence in the sample. Similarly, the level of activity of an enzyme present in a sample is determined by adding inhibitor to the sample in a range of titrating doses, and calculating activity of the enzyme at each escalating dose of inhibitor. The concentration of inhibitor that completely inhibits the enzyme in the assay, along with knowledge of the assay parameters and characteristic of enzyme inhibition, allows one to calculate the activity of the enzyme in the sample.
The level of chymotrypsin measured in stool samples in vitro is used as an indicator of pancreatitis (Riedel, L. et al. Gut 32:321-324 (1991); Chari, S., Trop. Gastroenterol. 11:144-147 (1990)). Chymotrypsin inhibitors of the present invention are useful in such assays to evaluate the level of active chymotrypsin in such a sample, according to protocols such as those outlined hereinabove. An additional use of the inhibitors of the present invention is their use to quench enzymatic reactions effected by the target enzyme. Thus, to control or prevent digestion of a sample with trypsin or chymotrypsin, an inhibitor of trypsin or chymoptrypsin, respectively, is added in inhibit the target enzume and, thus, control or prevent digestion by that enzyme.
Certain compounds of the present invention can also be useful inhibitors of elastase, and are therefore useful pharmaceutical agents for the control of inflammation.
To assist in understanding, the present invention will now be be further illustrated by the following examples.
These examples as they relate to this invention should not, of course, be construed as specifically limiting the invention and such variations of the invention, now known or later developed, which would be within the purview of one skilled in the art are considered to fall within the scope of the invention as described herein and hereinafter claimed.
Examples 1 to 11 describe preparation of compound 11 of Figure 1.
Examples 12 to 14 describe preparation of compound 19 of Figure 2.
Examples 15 to 19 describe preparation of intermediate 25 of Figure 3.
Examples 20 to 22 describe preparation of compound 28 of Figure 4. Examples 24 to 30 describe preparation of compound 41 of Figure 6.
Examples 31 to 33 describe preparation of compound 44 of. Figure 7.
EXAMPLES Example 1
Preparation of N- (2-Hvdroxy-4-methylphenyl)phthalimide (1) A solution of phthalic anhydride (14.81 g, 0.10 mole) and 6-amino-m-cresol (12.32 g, 0.10 mole) in "200 mL of acetic acid was stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes and then refluxed for 6 hours. The solution was cooled and poured into 500 mL ice-water with rapid stirring and the resultant solid was collected by suction filtration, washed with ice-cold water several times and air dried overnight to afford 24.1 g (95% yield) of product 1 as a light brown solid, p 251-254°C TLC (silica ; EtOAc) , Rf = 0.68.
Example 2 Preparation of N- (2-Allyloxy-4-methylphenyl)phthalimide (2 )
To a mixture of 1 (23.78 g, 0.0939 mole; see Example 1) and anhydrous K2CO3 (15.62 g, 0.113 mole) in 190 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile was added allyl bromide (17.04 g, 0.141 mole, 12.2 mL) . The mixture was stirred under N2 at room temperature for 15 minutes and then refluxed for 5 hours. The mixture was cooled, the solids were filtered and then washed with fresh acetonitrile/ethyl acetate, and the filtrate was evaporated. The residue was dissolved in 500 mL of ethyl acetate, extracted with 50 mL portions of saturated NaHC03 solution (2x) , water, brine and dried over anhydrous MgS04. Filtration and removal of solvent afforded 26.76 g
(97% yield) of product 2 as a light brown solid, mp 122-124°, judged pure by TLC (silica; CH2CI2), Rf = 0.45.
Example 3
Preparation of N- (2-Hvdroxy-3-allyl-4-methylphenyl) ph hali ide (31
A solution of 2 (2.93 g, 0.010 mole; see Example 2) in 6 mL of N,N-dimethylaniline under 2 was heated in an oil bath to 185°C (pot temperature) for 1.5 hours and then cooled. The reaction mixture was poured onto a flash silica gel column and eluted directly with a hexane, CH2Cl2 2,l to CH2CI2 gradient solvent system to afford 2.79 g (95% yield) of product 3 as a colorless solid, mp 178-180°C TLC (silica; CH2CI2) Rf = 0.25. Scale-up to 23.7 g and a reaction time of 2.5 hours afforded the product in 91% yield, identical in all respects with the above "material .
Example 4
Preparation of N- (2-Benzyloxy-3-allyl-4- methylphenyl) phthalimide (4 )
To a mixture of 3 (6.60 g, 0.0225 mole; see Example 3) and anhydrous K2CO3 (3.73 g, 0.027 mole) in 45 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile was added benzyl bromide (5.00 g, 0.0293 mole, 3.49 mL) . The mixture was stirred under N2 at room temperature for 15 minutes and then refluxed for 19 hours . The mixture was cooled and filtered; the collected solids were washed with fresh acetonitrile and the filtrate was evaporated. The residue was dissolved in 300 mL of ethyl acetate and extracted with 50 mL portions of saturated NaHC03 (2x) , water, brine and dried over anhydrous MgSθ4.
Filtration, solvent removal and recrystallization from 1- chlorobutane afforded product as a solid. The filtrate residue was flash chromatographed on silica gel, eluting with a hexane, CH2Cl2 2,l to CH2CI2 gradient to afford a total of 6.99 g (81% yield) 4 as a colorless solid, mp 107-109°C TLC (silica; CH2CI2, Hexane: 2,1), Rf= 0.30.
Example 5
Preparation of 2-Benzyloxy-3-allyl-4-methylaniline (5)
To a solution of 4 (7.67 g, 0.020 mole; see Example 4) in 100 mL of ethanol was added hydrazine monohydrate (1.22 g, 0.024 mole, 1.18 mL) . The reaction was stirred at. room temperature under N2 for 15 minutes, refluxed for 27 hours, cooled and filtered, and then the filtrate was evaporated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel, using a hexane, ethyl acetate: 9,1 to 4,1 gradient arid afforded 5.03 g (99% yield) of product 5 as a viscous light red-brown oil. TLC (silica; hexane, ethyl acetate: 2,1), Rf = 0.45.
Example 6 Preparation of N-Benzylsulfonanilide, 2-benzyloxy-3-allyl-4- methyl- (6)
To a solution of 5 (7.54 g, 0.0298 mole; see Example 5) and 4-methylmorpholine (9.04 g, 0.0894 mole, 9.83 mL) in 300 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile at 0°C under N2 was added α- toluene-sulfonyl chloride (11.36 g, 0.0596 mole) in one portion. The solution was stirred at 0°C for 1 hour and allowed to warm to and stir at ambient temperature for 19 hours. The solution was filtered and evaporated. The crude residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel using a hexane, CH2CI2 : 4,1 to CH2CI2 gradient system and afforded 12.05 g (99% yield) of product 6 as waxy reddish solid, mp 62-63°C TLC (silica; CH2CI2), Rf = 0.45.
Example 7 Preparation of 2-Benzyloxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- ethvlphenvlacetaldehvde (7)
A stream of ozone gas was introduced into a solution of
6 (10.71 g, 0.0263 mole; see Example 6) dissolved in 260 mL of methanol at -78°C until a pale blue color persisted. After 3 minutes, a stream of dry 2 was bubbled through the solution to discharge excess ozone. Dimethyl sulfide (3.27 g, 0.0526 mole, 3.86 mL) was added, the solution was stirred at -78°C for 5 minutes, and was allowed to warm to and then stir at ambient temperature for 14 hours . The solvent was evaporated to afford a residue which was dissolved in 350 mL of diethyl ether, extracted with 50 mL portions of water (2x) , brine, dried over anhydrous MgSθ4, filtered and evaporated to afford 11.73 g of a viscous oil. This oil was dissolved in 245 mL acetone and 75 mL of IN HCl was added. The solution was stirred at room temperature for 14 hours', refluxed for 30 minutes, cooled and evaporated. The residue was dissolved in 600 mL of diethyl ether and extracted with 50 mL portions of saturated NaHCθ3 , water (2x) , brine, and dried over MgSθ4- Filtration and solvent removal afforded 9.71 g (98% yield) of product 7 as a viscous yellow oil. TLC (silica; hexane, ethyl acetate: 2,1), Rf = 0.25.
Example 8
Preparation of 2-Benzyloxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetic acid (8) To a solution of 7 (9.70 g, 0.0237 mole; see Example 7) in 250 mL of acetone at 0°C was added Jones' reagent rapidly dropwise over a 30 minute period until a brown color persisted. The ice bath was removed and the mixture was allowed warm to room temperature. 2-Propanol (15 mL) was added and the mixture was stirred for 10 minutes. The mixture was diluted with 500 mL of ethyl acetate and filtered with suction through a pad composed of a homogeneous 1:1 mixture of celite and flash-grade silica gel. Elution with an additional 1 liter portion of acetone, ethyl acetate 1,1, followed by solvent removal afforded 10.30 g (-Quantitative crude yield) of product 8 as a sticky yellow foam, judged nearly pure by TLC (silica; CH2CI2, EtOH: 9,1), Rf=0.53. A portion recrystallized from diethyl ether and hexane afforded a colorless solid, mp 132-134°C Example 9
Preparation of N- r2-Benzyloxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyπ-Ng-nitro-L-argininal Ethyl Cvclol (9)
To a solution of 8 (9.16 g, 0.02153 mole; see Example 8) in 215 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile at room temperature under N2 was added N^-nitro-L-argininal ethyl cyclol (6.92 g,
0.0258 mole), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (3.30 g, 0.0215 mole) and l-ethyl-3- (3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide hydrochloride (6.19 g, 0.0323 mole). After stirring the mixture for 15 minutes, N,N-diisopropylethylamine (11.13 g, 0.0861 mole, 15.0 mL) was added and the resultant clear light brown solution was stirred at room temperature for 22 hours. The solvent was evaporated, the residue was slowly dissolved in 700 mL of ethyl acetate and was extracted with 50 mL portions of IN HCl (3x) , saturated NaHCθ3 (2x) , water (2x) , brine (2x), dried over MgS04, filtered and evaporated. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel using a CH2C12, EtOH: 99,1 to 95,5 gradient system to afford 9.49 g (69% yield) of product 9 as a light yellow foam. TLC (silica; ethyl acetate), Rf = 0.50.
Example 10
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyll -L-arσininal Ethyl Cvclol Acetate Salt flO)
To a solution of 9 (9.27 g, 0.0145 mole; see Example 9) in 370 mL of ethanol, acetic acid, water: 4,1,1 was added 10% Pd/C (9.3 g) . The mixture was hydrogenated at 60 PSI on a Parr shaker apparatus for 20 hours. The mixture was filtered and the solvents were evaporated. The residue was dissolved in ethanol, acetonitile 1,1, reevaporated, and pumped at < 1 mm Hg on a vacuum pump for 24 hours to afford 7.23 g (89% yield) of product 10 as a yellow foam. TLC (silica; CH2CI2, methanol, cone NH4OH: 20, 10, 2), Rf = 0.50. Example 11
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyll -L-argininal Trifluoroacetate Salt (11)
Compound 10 (1.01 g, 1.78 mmole; see Example 10) was added to a solution of 35 mL of 9.4 M HCIO4 at 0°C. The starting material slowly dissolved over 30 minutes and the reaction mixture was then frozen by immersion in a dry-ice acetone slurry. After warming to -15°C, the reaction mixture was adjusted to pH 5 by using a 10 M NaOH solution followed by a saturated NaOAc solution. During the neutralization process, the temperature was maintained at <10°C The solution was stored at 4°C for one hour, then the solids were filtered. The filtrate was purified by reverse phase HPLC on a 50 X 300 mm C18 column using a 0 to 28% gradient of acetonitrile/water (containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) over one hour to afford 0.66 g (63% yield) of product 11 as a colorless, amorphous solid. RP/HPLC analysis showed three peaks for the product. Mass spectrometry confirmed the theoretical molecular weight of 475.
Example 12
Preparation of N- (2-Methoxy-3-allyl-4- methylphenvDp thalimide .12)
To a mixture of 3 (6.00 g, 0.0205 mole; see Example 3) and anhydrous K2CO3 (3.39 g, 0.025 mole) in 41 mL of anhydrous acetonitrile was added iodomethane (5.81 g, 0.0409 mole, 2.54 mL) . The mixture was stirred under N2 at room temperatrure for 15 minutes and then refluxed for 17 hours. The mixture was cooled and filtered, the collected solids were washed with fresh acetonitrile and the filtrate was evaporated to afford 5.08 g (81% yield) of pure 12 as a colorless solid. TLC (silica; Hexane, ethyl acetate:l,l) , Rf = 0.50. Example 13
Preparation of N- r2-Methoxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonyl amino) -6- methylphenylacetyll -L-argininal Ethyl Cvclol Acetate Salt (18)
Compound 18 was prepared from compound 12 by following an analogous six-step protocol outlined above for the preparation of compound 10 from compound 4 (hydrazinolysis, benzylsulfonation, ozonolysis, oxidation, coupling and hydrogenation; see Examples 5 to 10) .
Example 14
Preparation of N- f2-Methoxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyll-L-argininal Trifluoroacetate Salt (19)
Compound 18 (1.00 g, 1.73 mmole) was added to a solution of 72 mL of 3N HCl and 5 mL of acetonitrile. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 hours, 10.0 mL of 6N HCl was added, and reaction was continued for a further 3.5 hours. The solution was filtered and purified by reverse phase HPLC on a 50 X 300 mm C18 column using a 5 to 30% gradient of acetonitrile/water (containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) over one hour and afforded 0.77 g (74% yield) of product 19 as a colorless, amorphous solid. RP/HPLC analysis showed three peaks for the product. Mass spectrometry confirmed the theoretical molecular weight of 489.
Example 15
Preparation of N- (t-butoxycarbonyl)-3- (3-pyridyl) -L-alanine
Figure imgf000071_0001
To a solution of N- ( t-butoxycarbonyl ) -3- (3- pyridyl) alanine (20) (5.0 g, 18.8 mmole) in methanol (100 mL) was added thionyl chloride (2M solution in dichloromethane, 66 mL, 132 mmole) . The resulting solution was stirred overnight at ambient temperature. The methanol was removed under reduced pressure to a minimum volume and ethyl acetate (100 mL) was added. The resulting white precipitate was collected in a fritted funnel. To a solution of the collected precipitate in a mixture of tetrahydrofuran/water (40 mL each) was added di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (4.8 g, 21.99 mmole) and sodium carbonate (1.95 g, 18.4 mmole). After stirring for 12 hours at ambient temperature, the reaction mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (40 mL) and washed with a solution of saturated sodium bicarbonate (25 mL) . The organic layer was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and concentrated under vacuum to give crude product. This product was subjected to flash column chromatography on silica gel (230-400 mesh) using a 8x52 cm column and eluting with a 10:90 mixture of ethyl acetate/hexane followed by a 60:40 mixture of ethyl acetate/hexane. 4 g (74%) of the title compound was obtained as an oil. Thin-layer chromatography (silica gel; ethyl acetate), Rf = 0.68.
Example 16
Preparation of N- (t-butoxycarbonyl) -3- ( _ R . SI -3-pjperidyl) -L- alanine methyl ester , acetate salt (22 )
Figure imgf000072_0001
A solution of the compound of Example 15 (5 g, 17 . 8 mmole) in ethanol (24 mL) , acetic acid (6 mL) and water ( 6 mL) was hydrogenated over platinum oxide (500 mg) at 45 psi for three hours . The catalyst was filtered off and the filtrate concentrated under vacuum to an oily residue (6.89 g) which was used in the next step (Example 17) without further purification. Thin-layer chromatography yielded two spots corresponding to two diastereomers with Rf values of 0.16 and 0.26, respectively (silica gel; 4:1:1 n-butanol/ acetic acid/water) .
Example 17
Preparation of N- (t-butoxycarbonyl) -3- \ (R. S) -3-pjperidyl- (N- guanidino (bis-benzyloxycarbonyl) ) 1 -L-alanine methyl ester (23)
Figure imgf000073_0001
To a solution of the compound of Example 16 (6.89 g, 19.9 mmole) in tetrahydrofuran (80 mL) was added S- methylisothiourea bis-benzyloxycarbonyl (7.13 g, 19.9 mmole) followed by N-methylmorpholine (4.37 mL) , and the reaction mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 18 hours. The reaction mixture then was concentrated under vacuum and the resulting residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (100 mL) and washed with IN sodium bisulfate and saturated sodium chloride (50 mL each) . After drying over anhydrous sodium sulfate, the solvents were removed under vacuum; the crude title compound was subjected to flash column chromatography on silica gel (230-400 mesh) using a 8x52 cm column and eluting with 1:9 ethyl acetate/hexanes (two column volumes) followed by 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes. 2.75 g the title compound was obtained as a mixture of two diastereomers. Thin-layer chromatography gave two spots with Rf values of 0.57 and 0.62, respectively (silica gel; 1:1 ethyl acetate/ hexanes) .
Example 18
Preparation of N- ( t-butoxycarbonyl ) -3- r (R. S) -3-pjperidyl- (N- guanidino (bis-benzyloxycarbonyl) ) 1 -L-alaninol (24 )
Figure imgf000074_0001
To a stirred solution of the compound of Example 17 (2.23 g, 3.7 mmole) in absolute ethanol (8 mL) and anhydrous tetrahydrofuran (4 mL) was added calcium chloride (844 mg, 7.6 mmole) and sodium borohydride (575 mg, 15.2 mmole) . After stirring 12 hours at ambient temperature, the reaction mixture was concentrated under vacuum and the resulting residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and IN sodium bisulfate (10 mL each) . The two layers were separated; organic layer was washed twice more with IN sodium bisulfate, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and concentrated under vacuum gave a residue. Flash column chromatography of the residue on silica gel (230-400 mesh) using a 5.5x45 cm column and eluting with ethyl acetate gave 1.3 g of the title compound as a white foam. Thin layer chromatography yielded two spots corresponding to two diastereomers with Rf values of 0.18 and 0.27, respectively (silica gel; 1:1 ethyl acetate/ hexanes) . Example 19
Preparation of 3- T (R. S) -3-piperidyl- (N-guanidino (bis- benzyloxycarbonyl) ) 1-L-alaninol. hydrochloride salt (25)
Figure imgf000075_0001
The compound of Example 18 (290 mg, 0.57 mmole) was treated with 2.5 N anhydrous hydrochloric acid in ethyl acetate (2.0 mL) at ambient temperature for one hour. The solvent was removed under vacuum to a sticky-white solid (260 mg) . This solid was used in the next step (Example 9) without further purification. ^-H NMR spectrum taken in CD3OD showed no t-butoxycarbonyl protons at 1.4 ppm.
Example 20
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenyl-acetvn -3- f (R. S) -3-pjperidyl- (N-ouanidino fbis- benzyloxycarbonyl) ) 1 -L-alaninol (26) To a suspension of the Compound of Example 19 (25) (2.06 g, 4.08 mmole) in "acetonitrile (22 mL) is added successively the compound of Example 8 (8) (2.36 g, 5.56 mmole), EDC (1.12 g, 5.84 mmole), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (979 mg, 6.39 mmole), and N-methylmorpholine (3 mL, 27.80 mmole). The solution is stirred at ambient temperature for about twenty hours. The solvent is removed under vacuum and the resulting residue is dissolved in a 9:1 mixture of dichloromethane/isopropanol (40 mL) and washed two times each with 15 mL portions of IN sodium bisulfate, saturated sodium bicarbonate and saturated sodium chloride. The organic layer is dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and concentrated under vacuum to give the title compound. The product is a mix of diastereomers at Pi and has a calculated molecular weight of 875.05.
Example 21
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzvlsulfonvlamino) -6- ethylphenyl-acetyll -3- T (R. S) -3-pjperidinyl- (N-guanidino) 1 -L- alaninol (27) The compound of Example 20 (26) (1.97 g, 2.25 mmole) is subjected to catalytic hydrogenation in methanol (100 mL) and acetic acid (10 mL in the presence of 10% palladium on carbon (185 mg) at 30 psi for about 2.5 hours. The catalyst is filtered. The filtrate after concentration under vacuum yields the title compound as two diastereomers with a calculated molecular weight of 577.7. Example 22
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenyl-acetyll -3- r3-piperidinyl- (N-guanidino) -L- alaninal and separation of diasteromers (28a and 28b) To a chilled solution of the compound of Example 21 (27) (0.81 g, 1.4 mmole) in dimethylsulfoxide and toluene (15 mL each) is added dichloroacetic acid (567 μL, 6.9 mmole), followed by EDC (2.68 g, 14 mmole) at one minute later. The reaction mixtue is stirred for about 5 minutes at O'C, then about 85 minutes at ambient temperature, and then is quenched with 60 L water. The water layer is extracted twice with diethyl ether (10 mL portions) and subjected to HPLC using a 47 X 300 mm reverse phase column continuing a C-18 resin comprised of 10 micron-size gel particles with a 300 angstrom pore size. The column is eluted with a gradient ranging from 15% to 30% acetonitrile in water (containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) . The HPLC fractions will yield fast moving and slow moving peaks containing the two diastereomers of the title compound. The fractions containing each diastereomer when pooled, then lyophilized, will give the two diastereomers of the title compound, (28a and 28b) .
Example 23
Preparation semicarbazid-4-yl diphenyl ethane . trifluoroacetate salt
Figure imgf000077_0001
Step 1: A solution of carbonyldiimidazole (16.2 g, 0.10 mole) in 225 mL of dimethylformamide was prepared at room temperature and allowed to stir under nitrogen. A solution of t-butyl carbazate (13.2 g, 0.100 moles) in 225 mL dimethylformamide was then added dropwise over a 30 minute period. Next, diphenylmethylamine (18.3 g, 0.10 moles) was added over a 30 minute period. The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature under nitrogen for one hour. Water (10 mL) was added and this mixture was concentrated to about 150 mL under vacuum. This solution was poured into 500 mL water and extracted with 400 mL of ethyl acetate. The ethyi acetate phase was extracted two times each with 75 mL IN HCl, water, saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine, and then was dried with anhydrous magnesium sulfate. The mixture was filtered and the solution was concentrated to give 29.5 g (85% yield) of l-t-butoxycarbonyl-semicarbazid-4-yl diphenylmethane as a white foam. This material may be purified by recrystallization from ethyl acetate/hexane, but was pure enough to use directly in step 2: mp 142-143°C 1H NMR (CDCI3) delta 1.45 (s, 9H) , 6.10 (dd, 2H) , 6.42 (s, IH) ,
6.67 (bs, IH) , 7.21-7.31 (m, 10H) . Analysis calculated for C19H23N3O3: C, 66.84; H, 6.79; N, 12.31. Found: C, 66.46; H, 6.75; N; 12.90.
Step 2:
A solution of 3.43 g (10 mmole) of 1-t-butoxycarbonyl- semicarbazid-4-yl diphenylmethane in 12.5 mL of dichloromethane was treated with 12.5 mL of trifluoroacetic acid at 0°C The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 30 minutes at this temperature. The reaction mixture was then added dropwise to 75 mL of diethyl ether to give a precipitate. The resulting precipitate was filtered off and washed with diethyl ether to give 2.7 g (80% yield) of the title compound; mp 182-184°C Example 24
Preparation of 3-thioamidobenzyl-N-acetylaminomalonic acid diethyl ester ( 3 5 )
Figure imgf000079_0001
To a stirred solution of alpha-bromo-meta-tolunitrile (32) (45.0 g, 0.24 mole), diethyl acetamidomalonate (33) (48.0 g, 0.22 mole) and potassium iodide (3.0 g, 0.018 mole) in dioxane (500 mL) was added 2.5M sodium ethoxide in ethanol (100 mL) dropwise under an argon atmosphere. After the addition was complete, the solution was refluxed for 6 hours. The reaction mixture was allowed to stand overnight at room temperature, then diluted with brine (250 mL) and water (250 mL) , and extracted with ethyl acetate four times (1.0 L total) . The combined extracts were washed with water (100 mL) , 10% citric acid (100 mL) , water (100 mL) and brine (2x50 mL) , then dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate and filtered; the solvent was removed under vacuum. The crude residue was recrystallized from ethyl acetate and diethyl ether in two crops to yield 43.51 g (60%) of the 3- cyanobenzyl-N-acetylaminomalonic acid diethyl ester (34) as yellow crystals.
H2S(g) was bubbled into a rapidly stirring solution of 3-cyanobenzyl-N-acetylaminomalonic acid diethyl ester (44.3 g, 0.13 mmole) in pyridine (300 mL) and triethylamine (100 mL) for 40 minutes. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 16 hours, then poured into 3.0 L of water. A yellow precipitate formed immediately. The solution was allowed to stand at 4°C for 4 hours, then was filtered. The crude title compound was recrystallized from ethyl acetate and hexanes to yield 48.1 g (98%) of the title compound as yellow crystals, m.p. 183-186°C ^ NMR (CDC13) : delta 1.31
( t, J=7.1 Hz, 6H) , 2.06 (s, 3H) , 3.70 (s, 2H) , 4.29 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 4H) , 4.80-4.87 (m, IH) , 6.60 (s, IH) , 7.10-7.20 (m, IH) , 7.27-7.35 (m, 2H) , 7.60-7.70 (m, 2H) . Analysis calculated for Cι7H22N2θ5S : C, 55 .72 ; H, 6. 05 ; N, 7 . 64 .
Found: C, 55 .55 ; H, 5 .96 ; N, 7 .76 .
Example 25 Preparation of 3-amidino-D.L-phenylalanine. dihvdrochloride salt (36)
Figure imgf000080_0001
The compound of Example 24 (35) (48.1 g, 0.13 mmole) was dissolved in acetone (800 mL) . Iodomethane (18.3 mL, 0.19 mole, 1.5 equivalents) was added, and the solution was refluxed for 30 minutes. The solution was cooled to room temperature, and the intermediate thioimidate was filtered, dried and dissolved in methanol (500 mL) . Ammonium acetate
(14.8 g, 0.19 mole, 1.5 equivalents) was added. The reaction mixture was refluxed for 1 hour, then cooled to room temperature, and poured into ether (1.2 L) . The solution was allowed to stand at 4°C for 72 hours. The crude 3- amidinobenzyl-N-acetylaminomalonic acid diethyl ester was filtered, washed with ether, air dried, and then refluxed in concentrated HCl (250 mL) for 3 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under vacuum, diluted with water (0.5 L) , and concentrated under vacuum again. These steps were repeated. The crude title compound was purified by cation- exchange (Sephadex SP-C25) using a gradient of 0-1. ON HCl as eluent to yield 10.8g (30%) of the title compound as an off- white solid. *H NMR (D20) : delta 3.14-3.29 (2H, m) , 4.17
(dd, J=7.4, 6.2 Hz, IH) , 7.42-7.69 (4H, m) . Analysis calculated for C10H13N3O2 -2HC1 -1.9H20: C, 38.20; H, 6.03; N,
13.36. Found: C, 38.51; H, 5.64; N, 12.89.
Example 26
Preparation of N-alpha-Boc-N-ω-4-methoχy-2.3.6- trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-3-amidino-D.L-phenylalanine (37)
Figure imgf000081_0001
3-amidino-D,L-phenylalanine (the compound of Example 25, (36)) (4.00 g, 13 mmole) was dissolved in 50% aqueous dioxane (20 mL) . Sodium bicarbonate (3.38 g, 40 mmole) was added, followed by di-t-butyl dicarbonate (2.93 g, 13 mmole) in dioxane (4 mL) . The reaction mixture was stirred for 18 hours at room temperature. The solution was cooled in an ice bath, and 4.0 N sodium hydroxide was added dropwise until the solution was pH 12. 4-me hoxy-2, 3, 6-trimethylbenzenesulfonyl chloride (8.01 g, 32 mmole) in dioxane (10 mL) was added dropwise. 4.0 N sodium hydroxide was added as needed to keep the pH at 12. The ice bath was removed. After 1 hour, 1.0 N HCl was added to bring the solution to pH 7-8. The solution - was diluted with an additional 50 mL of water and then was washed with ethyl acetate two times (20 mL each) . The aqueous layer was acidified to pH 1.0 with 1.0 N HCl and extracted with ethyl acetate three times (100 mL total) . The combined organic layers were washed with water (20 mL) and brine twice (10 L each) . The organic layer was dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate and the solvent was removed under vacuum. The residue was dissolved in a minimum amount of dichloromethane, then added dropwise to ether (25 mL) . Solid impurities were removed by filtering and the solvent removed from the filtrate under vacuum to give 4.90 g (68% crude yield) of the title compound as an off-white foam. A 30 mg sample of the title compound was further purified by preparative thin-layer- chromatograph developing with 1% acetic acid/5% isopropanol/ dichloromethane to give 9 mg of the title compound in a purer form. Rf = 0.16 (1% acetic acid/5% isopropanol/dichloromethane) . ^-H NMR (CD3OD) : del'ta
1.32 (s, 9H) , 2.14 (s, 3H) , 2.63 (s, 3H) , 2.71 (s, 3H) , 2.93 (dd, J=13.7, 9.3 Hz, IH) , 3.22 (dd, J=13.7, 4.3 Hz, IH) , 3.85 (s, 3H), 4.34-4.37 (m, IH) , 6.72 (s, IH) , 7.35-7.47 (2H, m) , 7.69-7.75 (m, 2H) .
Example 27
Preparation of N-alpha-Boc-N-ω-4-methoxy-2.3.6- trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-3-amidino-D.L-phenylalanine-N- methyl-O-methyl-carboxamide (38)
Figure imgf000082_0001
To a stirred solution of compound of Example 26 (37) (1.00 g, 1.92 mmole), 0,N-dimethyl hydroxylamine hydrochloride (375 mg, 3.85 mmole), hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (294 mg, 1.92 mmole) and 4-methylmorpholine (1.06 mL, 9.62 mmole) in tetrahydrofuran (4 mL) , cooled in an ice bath, was added EDC (406 mg, 2.12 mmole) . The ice bath was removed, and the reaction mixture was stirred for 2 hours at room temperature. The reaction mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (75 mL) , washed with water, 10% citric acid, water, saturated sodium bicarbonate, and brine. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate and the solvent was removed under vacuum. 750 mg (69%) of the title compound was isolated. 1H NMR (CDCI3) : delta 1.33 (s, 9H) ,
2.14 (s, 3H) , 2.66 (s, 3H) , 2.75 (s, 3H) , 2.80-2.88 (m, IH) , 3.06-3.20 (m, 4H) , 3.70 (s, 3H) , 3.84 (s, 3H) , 4.98-5.06 (m, IH) , 5.21 (d, J=8.7 Hz, IH) , 6.48 (bs, IH) , 6.58 (s, IH) , 7.30-7.34 (m, 2H) 7.60-7.68 (m, 2H) , 8.11 (bs, IH) . Analysis calculated for C27H38N4θ7S- 0.5^0: C, 56.73; H, 6.88; N,
9.80. Found: C, 56.97; H, 6.66; N, 9.43.
Example 28
Preparation of N-alpha-Boc-N-ω-4-methoxy-2.3.6- trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-D. L-3-amidinophenylalaninal (39)
Figure imgf000083_0001
To a stirred solution of LiAlH4 (2.00 mL of a 1.0 M solution in tetrahydrofuran, 1.24 mmole) in tetrahydrofuran (8 mL) , cooled in a dry ice/acetone bath, the compound of Example 27 (38) (0.75 g, 1.9 mmole in tetrahydrofuran (5 mL) ) was added dropwise. The cooling bath was removed and the reaction mixture was allowed to warm to 5°C The reaction mixture was re-cooled in the dry ice acetone bath and quenched with 3.0 mL of a 1:2.7 wt./wt. solution of potassium bisulfate in water. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature, stirred for 3 hours, filtered and concentrated under vacuum. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (20 mL) , and washed with 10% citric acid (2 mL) , water (2 mL) , saturated sodium bicarbonate (2 mL) and brine (2 mL) . The organic layer was dried over anydrous magnesium sulfate and the solvent was removed under vacuum to yield 580 mg (86%) of the title compound. λH NMR (CDCI3) : delta 1.31 (s, 9H) , 2.07 (s, 3H) , 2.57 (s, 3H) , 2.67 (s, 3H) ,2.90-3.17 (2H, m) , 3.77 (s, 3H) , 4.33-4.40 (IH, m) , 5.02- 5.08 (IH, m) , 6.48 (IH, s) , 7.23-7.31 (2H, m) , 7.50-7.62 (2H, m) , 7.94, (IH, bs) , 8.05 (IH, bs) , 9.55 (IH, s) . Analysis calculated for C 5H33N3θ6S- 0.5H2O: C, 58.58; H, 6.69;
N,8.20. Found: C, 58.57; H, 6.72; N, 7.98.
Example 29 Preparation of N-alpha-Boc-N-ω-4-methoxy-2.3.6- trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-D,L-3-amidinophenylalaninal- semicarbazonyl-4-N-diphenylmethane (40)
Figure imgf000084_0001
The compound of Example 28 (39) (0.58 g, 1.9 mmole), the compound of Example 23 (410 mg, 1.15 mmole) and sodium acetate trihydrate (188 mg, 1.38 mmole) were refluxed in 75% aqueous ethanol (10 mL) for 1 hour. After the reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature, it was diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) , washed with 1.0N HCl (5 mL) , water (5 mL) , saturated sodium bicarbonate (5 mL) and brine (2x5 mL) , and dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate. The solvent was removed under vacuum to yield 750 mg (89% yield) of the title compound as an off-white foam. Analysis calculated for C39H46N6O6S-1.0 H20: C, 62.88; H, 6.49; N, 11.28. Found:
C, 63.14; H, 6.35 N, 11.10. Calculated molecular weight was 726.90. Example 30
Preparation of N-ω-4-methoxy-2.3 , 6-trimethylbenzene sulfonyl-
D.L-3-amidinophenylalaninal-semicarbazonyl-4-N- diphenylmethane . trifluoroacetate salt (41)
Figure imgf000085_0001
The compound of Example 29 (40) (750 mg, 1.9 mmole) was treated with 50% trifluoroacetic acid/dichloromethane (3 mL) for 30 minutes at room temperature. The reaction mixture was added dropwise to ether (50 mL) . The solution was allowed to stand at 4°C for 18 hours. The product was filtered, and dried under vacuum to yield 600 mg (79% yield) of the title compound as an off-white solid. Analysis calculated for C34H38N604S-1.3CF3C0H: C, 56.72; H> 5.11; N, 10.84.
Found: C, 56.34; H, 5.47; N, 11.49 . The salt had a calculated molecular weight of 740.8.
Example 31
Preparation of N- r2-Benzyloxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methvlphenyl-acetyll -D. L-N-ω-4-methoxv-2.3.6- trimethvlbenzenesulfonyl-D.L-3-amidinophenvlalaninal- semicarbazonyl-4-N-diphenylmethane (42) EDC (180.1 mg, 0.94 mmole) is added in one portion to a stirred solution of the compound of Example 8 (8) (209 mg, 0.49 mmole), hydroxybenzotriazole (75 mg, 0.49 mmole), and 4- methylmorpholine (0.24 L, 2.2 mmole) in dimethylformamide (5 mL) with cooling in an ice bath. After 30 minutes, the compound of Example 30 (41) (363 mg, 0.49 mmole) is added. After an additional 22 hours, the reaction mixture is diluted with water (25 mL) and brine (25 mL) . The product is filtered and dissolved in ethyl acetate (125 mL) . The solution is washed with 10% citric acid, water, saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine, and is dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate. The solvent is removed under vacuum. The resulting residue is chromatographed by flash chromatography on silica gel to give the title compound.
Example 32
Preparation of N- r2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzyl-sulfonylamino) -6- methylphenyl-acetyl-D ■ L-3-amidinophenylalaninal semicarbazone (43)
The compound of Example 31 (42) (100 mg) is treated with hydrofluoric acid/anisole (9:1) for 30 minutes at -20°C and 0°C for 30 minutes. After removal of the hydrofluoric acid, the resulting residue is dissolved in 20% aqueous acetic acid and washed with diethyl ether. The aqueous layer is lyophilized to a powder, then is purified by preparative HPLC (C-18, eluting with 10-40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) to give the title compound.
Example 33
Preparation of N-f2-Hvdroxy-3- (N-benzylsulfonylamino) -6- methylphenylacetyl1 -D. L-3-a idinophenvlalaninal (44)
Figure imgf000086_0001
The compound of Example 32 (43) (50 mg, 32 micromoles) is dissolved in methanol (1 mL) and 1% aqueous trifluoroacetic acid (5 mL) , then formalin (0.23 mL) is added. After 40 minutes, the solution is filtered through a 2 micron filter, diluted to a volume of 15 mL with water, and then is purified by preparative HPLC (C-18, eluting with 10- 40% acetonitrile-water gradient containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid) . The fractions containing the title compound are pooled and lyophilized to give the title compound.
Example A
Kinetic Analysis of Compounds in an in vi tro Thrombin Inhibition Assay The ability of the compounds of Example 11 and 14 to act as an inhibitor of thrombin catalytic activity was assessed by determining the compounds' inhibition constant, Ki.
Enzyme activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate Pefachrome t-PA (CH3S02-D-hexahydrotyrosine-glycyl- L-arginine-p-Nitroanilide) , obtained from Pentapharm Ltd. The substrate was reconstituted in deionized water prior to use. Purified human alpha-thrombin (3000U/mg specific activity) was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. The buffer used for all assays was HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodivim chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin) . The assay for Ki determinations was conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 100 microliters of HBSA or the test compound at a specified concentration diluted in HBSA (or HBSA alone for V0 (uninhibited velocity) measurement), and 100 microliters of the chromogenic substrate (750 μM, 5X Km) . At time zero, 50 microliters of alpha-thrombin diluted in HBSA were added to the wells, yielding a final concentration of 0.2 nM in a total volume of 250 microliters. Velocities of chromogenic substrate hydrolysis which occurred over 60 minutes were measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader. Ki values were determined for test compounds using the relationships developed by Williams and Morrison, Methods in Enzymology, 61: 437 (1979) using steady state velocities (Vs) measured over 60 minutes. The extent of substrate hydrolysis was less than 5% over the course of this assay.
Table 1 below gives the Ki values for the compounds of Examples 11 and 14. The data show the utility of these compounds as potent in vitro inhibitors of human alpha- thrombin.
Table 1
Figure imgf000088_0001
Example B
In vi tro Enzyme Assays for Specificity Determination
The ability of compounds of this invention to act as a selective inhibitor of thrombin catalytic activity was assessed by determining the concentration of test compound which inhibited the activity of this enzyme by 50%, (IC50), and comparing this value to that determined for some or all of the following related serine proteases : recombinant tissue plasminogen activator (rt-PA) , plasmin, activated protein C (aPC) , chymotrypsin and trypsin.
The buffer used for all assays was HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodium chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin). The assay for IC50 determinations was conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 50 microliters of HBSA, 50 microliters of the test compound at a specified concentration (covering a broad concentration range) diluted in HBSA (or HBSA alone for V0 (uninhibited velocity) measurement) , and 50 microliters of the enzyme diluted in HBSA. Following a 30-minute incubation at ambient temperature, 50 microliters of the substrate at the concentrations specified below were added to the wells, yielding a final total volume of 200 microliters. The initial velocity of chromogenic substrate hydrolysis was measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized. The concentration of added inhibitor which caused a 50% decrease in the initial rate of hydrolysis was defined as the IC50 value .
1. Thrombin (flla) Assay
Enzyme activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, Pefachrome t-PA (CH3Sθ2-D-hexahydrotyrosine- glycyl-L-Arginine-p-nitroaniline, obtained from Pentapharm
Ltd. ) . The substrate was reconstituted in deionized water prior to use. Purified human α-thrombin was obtained from
Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. The buffer used for all assays was HBSA (10 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 150 mM sodium chloride, 0.1% bovine serum albumin) .
IC50 determinations were conducted where HBSA (50 μl) , α-thrombin (50 μl) (the final enzyme concentration is 0.5 nM) and inhibitor (50 μl) (covering a broad concentration range) were combined in appropriate wells and incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature prior to the addition of substrate Pefachrome-t-PA (50 μl) (the final substrate concentration is 250 μM, about 5 times Km) . The initial velocity of Pefachrome t-PA hydrolysis was measured by the change in absorbance at 405 nm using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized. The concentration of added inhibitor which caused a 50% decrease in the initial rate of hydrolysis was defined as the IC50 value. 2. Recombinant tissue plasminogen activator (rt-PA) rt-PA catalytic activity was determined using the substrate, Pefachrome t-PA (CH3Sθ2-D-hexahydrotyrosine- glycyl-L-arginine-p-nitroanilide, obtained from Pentapharm Ltd.). The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 500 micromolar (about 3-times Km) . Human rt-PA (Activase®) was obtained from Genentech Inc. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM.
3. Plasmin Assay Plasmin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2366 (L-pyro-Glu-Pro-Arg-pNa-HCl), which was obtained from DiaPharma Group. The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 300 micromolar (about 2.5-times Km) . Purified human plasmin was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM.
4. Activated Protein C (aPC) aPC catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, Pefachrome PC (delta-carbobenzloxy-D- lysine-L-prolyl-L-arginine-p-nitroanilide) , obtained from Pentapharm Ltd. ) . The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 400 micromolar (about 3- times Km) . Purified human aPC was obtained from Hematologic Technologies, Inc. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 1.0 nM. 5. Chymotrypsin
Chymotrypsin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2586 (methoxy-succinyl-L-arginine-L- prolyl-L-tyrosyl-p-nitroanilide) , which was obtained from DiaPharma Group. The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 100 micromolar (about 9- times Km) . Purified (3X-crystallized; CDI) bovine pancreatic a-chymotrypsin was obtained from Worthington Biochemical Corp. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 0.5 nM.
6. Trypsin Trypsin catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate, S-2222 (benzoyl-L-isoleucine-L- glutamic acid- (gamma-methyl ester) -L-arginine-p- nitroanilide) , which was obtained from DiaPharma Group. The substrate was made up in deionized water followed by dilution in HBSA prior to the assay in which the final concentration was 250 micromolar (about 4-times Km) . Purified (3X- crystallized; TRL3) bovine pancreatic trypsin was obtained from Worthington Biochemical Corp. The enzyme was reconstituted in deionized water and diluted into HBSA prior to assay in which the final concentration was 0.5 nM.
7. Factor Xa
Factor Xa catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate S-2765 (N-benzyloxycarbonyl-D-arginine- L-glycine-L-arginine-p-nitroaniline) , obtained from DiaPharma Group (Franklin, OH) . All substrates were reconstituted in deionized water prior to use. The final concentration of S- 2765 was 250 μM (about 5-times Km) . Purified human Factor X was obtained from Enzyme Research Laboratories, Inc. (South Bend, IN) and Factor Xa (FXa) was activated and prepared from it as described [Bock, P.E., Craig, P.A., Olson, S.T., and Singh, P. Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 273:375-388 (1989)]. The enzyme was diluted into HBSA prior to assay, in which the final concentration was 0.25 nM.
Table 2 lists the determined IC50 values for the compounds of Examples 11 and 14 as inhibitors of some of the enzymes listed above and demonstrates the high degree of specificity for the inhibition of alpha-thrombin compared to these related serine proteases.
Table 2 50 values for the inhibition of human alpha thrombin amidolvtic activity compared to selected serine proteases for compounds of Example 11 and 14
Figure imgf000092_0001
*-No inhibition observed at the maximal concentration of inhibitor assayed-2500nM.
Example C
Ex Vivo Anticoagulant Effects of Compounds in Rat and Humaη
Plasma
The ex. vivo anticoagulant effects of compounds of the present invention are determined by measuring the prolongation of the activated partial thromboplastin time (APTT) over a broad concentration range of the added inhibitor, using pooled normal human and rat plasma.
Fresh frozen citrated pooled normal human plasma is obtained from George King Biomedical, Overland Park, KA. Pooled normal rat plasma is prepared from citrated whole blood collected from anesthetized rats using standard procedures. The plasma is flash frozen and stored at -80°C until use.
Measurements of APTT are made using the Coag-A-Mate k4 automated coagulometer (General Diagnostics, Organon
Technica, Oklahoma City, OK) using the Automated APTT reagent (Organon Technica, Durham, NC) as the initiator of clotting according to the manufacturers instructions. The assay is conducted by making a series of dilutions of the test compounds into 100 μl rapidly thawed plasma followed by adding 200 microliters of APTT reagent and calcium chloride, to the wells of the assay carousel. Compounds that prolong the APTT in a dose-dependent manner are considered to demonstrate an anticoagulant effect.
Example D
Evaluation of the Antithrombotic Potential of Compounds in an
Experimental Rat Model of Thrombosis
The antithrombotic (prevention of thrombus formation) properties of compounds of the present invention are evaluated using the following established experimental model of acute vascular thrombosis which is a rat model of FeCl3~ induced platelet-dependent arterial thrombosis.
This is a well characterized model of platelet dependent, arterial thrombosis which has been used in the evaluation potential antithrombotic compounds such as direct thrombin inhibitors. See, Kurz, K. D., Main, B. W. , and Sandusky, G. E., Thromb. Res., ££: 269-280 (1990). In this model a platelet-rich, occlusive thrombus is formed in a segment of the rat carotid artery treated locally with a fresh solution of FeCl3 absorbed to a piece of filter' paper. The FeCl3 is thought to diffuse into the treated segment of artery and causes de-endothelialization of the affected vessel surface. This results in the exposure of blood to subendothelial structures which in turn causes platelet adherence, thrombin formation and platelet aggregation resulting in occlusive thrombus formation. The effect of a test compound on the incidence of occlusive thrombus formation following the application of the FeCl3 is monitored by ultrasonic flowtometry and is used as the primary end point. The use of flowtometry to measure carotid artery blood flow, is a modification of the original procedure in which thermal detection of clot formation was employed. See, Kurz, K. D., Main, B. W. , and Sandusky, G. E., Thromb. Res., 61: 269-280 (1990) . Male Harlan Sprague Dawley rats (420-450 g) are acclimated at least 72 hours prior to use and fasted for 12 hours prior to surgery with free access to water. The animals are prepared, anesthetized with Nembutal followed by the insertion of catheters for blood pressure monitoring, drug and anesthesia delivery. The left carotid artery is isolated by making a midline cervical incision followed by blunt dissection and spreading techniques to separate a 2 cm segment of the vessel from the carotid sheath. A silk suture is inserted under the proximal and distal ends of the isolated vessel to provide clearance for the placement of a ultrasonic flow probe (Transonic) around the proximal end of the vessel. The probe is then secured with a stationary arm. Following surgery the animals are randomized in either a control (saline) or treatment group with test compound, with at least 6 animals per group per dose. The test compound is administered as a single intravenous bolus at doses of about 0.3 to 5.0 mg/kg after placement of the flow probe and 5 minutes prior to the thrombogenic stimulus. At t=0, a 3mm diameter piece of filter paper (Whatman #3) soaked with 10 microliters of a 35% solution of fresh FeCl3 (made up in water) is applied the segment of isolated carotid artery distal to .the flow probe. Blood pressure, blood flow, heart rate, and respiration are monitored for 60 minutes.
The incidence of occlusion (defined as the attainment of zero blood flow) is recorded as the primary end point. The efficacy of test compounds as an antithrombotic agent in preventing thrombus formation in this in vivo model is demonstrated by the reduction in the incidence of thrombotic occlusion. The effective dose which prevents 50% of thrombotic occlusions in this model (ED50) can be determined from the above data by plotting the incidence of occlusion versus the dose administered. This allows a direct comparison of the antithrombotic efficacy of test compounds with other antithrombotic agents which have also been evaluated in this model as . Table 3 lists the ED50 values for several well known anticoagulant agents in this model (Heparin-Hirsh, J. N. Engl . J. Med., 121:1565-1574 (1992), Cairns, J.A. et. al. Chest, 1&2 :456S-481S (1992); Argatroban- Gold, H.K. et.al., J. Am. Coll. Cardiol., 21:1039-1047 (1993); and Hirulog^-Sharma, G.V.R.K. et.al., Am. J. Cardiol., 22:1357-1360 (1993) and Lidόn, R.M. et.al., Circulation, 11:1495-1501 (1993)).
Table 3 Efficacy of known antithrombotic agents based on ED50 for thrombus prevention in the FeCl^ model of arterial thrombosis
Compound ED50a
Standard Heparin 200 U/kg
Argatroban 3.8 mg/kg
Hirulogt111 3.0 mg/kg
aED5o is defined as the dose that prevents the incidence of complete thrombotic occlusion in 50% of animals tested. The in vivo comparison of compounds of the present invention with the clinically effective antithrombotic agents Standard Heparin, Argatroban, and Hirulogtm in the same rodent model of experimental thrombosis coupled with demonstrated anticoagulant effects of the present compounds in both rat and human plasma described above in Example C would lead one skilled in the art to conclude that this compound will be an effective antithrombotic agent in humans .
Example E Elastase Assay
Elastase catalytic activity was determined using the chromogenic substrate Elastase Substrate I (MeOSuc-Ala-Ala- Pro-Val-p-nitroanaline, obtained from Calbiochem) . The substrate was reconstituted with 10% DMSO and assay buffer. Human Neutrophil Elastase was obtained from Calbiochem and diluted in the assay uffer prior to use. The assay buffer diluted in the assay buffer prior to use. The assay buffe was HBS (10 mM HEPES, 150 mM sodium chloride, pH 7.5) with 0.1% Tween 80 and 10% DMSO. The DMSO is necessary to keep the substrate from precipitating during the course of the assay.
IC50 determinations were conducted by combining in appropriate wells of a Corning microtiter plate, 50 microliters of the test compound at a specified concentration (covering a broad concentration range) diluted in buffer (or buffer along for VQ (uninhibited velocity) measurement) , and
50 microliters of the enzyme diluted in buffer, yielding an enzme concentration of 1 nM. Following a 30 minute incubation at ambient temperature, 100 microliters of the substrate were added to the wells, yielding a final volume of 200 microliters, and a substrate concentration of 750 μM (about 6 times Km) . The initial velocity of substrate hydrolysis was measured by the change of absorbance at 405 nM using a Thermo Max® Kinetic Microplate Reader over a 5 minute period in which less than 5% of the added substrate was utilized. The concentration of added inhibitor which caused a 50% decrease in the initial rate of hydrolysis was defined as the IC50 value.

Claims

We claim:
1. A compound of the formula:
Figure imgf000098_0001
wherein
(a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S (.0) 2- f -N(R')-S(0)2-, -C(=0)-, -OC(=0)-, -NH-C(=0)-, -P(0)(R")- and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is -NHR', -OR' , -R' , or -SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
(1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, (2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R' , (3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 ' alkoxy, or -CO2R',
(4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R', (5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or
-C02R',
(6) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
(7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(8) heteroaryl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2. and/or Y3,
(9) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with.Yi, Y2. and/or Y3, (10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0) , which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(11) aralkeπyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or
Y3' (12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2. and/or Y3,
Figure imgf000100_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,
(19) perfluoroaralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and
ΓÇö v ΓÇóN v
(21) ^ΓÇö' , wherein is a 5 to 7 membered heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is -CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2- or -S-, and wherein Yi, Y2, and Y3 are
(i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, -CH(CF3)2, -C(OH) (CF3) 2 > -OCF3, -OCF2CF3, -0C(0)NH2, -0C(0)NHZ╬╣, -OC(0)NZlZ2, -NHC(0)Z╬╣, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NHZl, -NHC (0)NZlZ2 , -C(0)OH, -C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZl, -C(0)NZlZ2, -C(0)OZ1, -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)OH, -P.(0)3(Zl)2┬╗ -S(0)3H , -S(0)mZ1/ -Z╬╗ , -OZlf -OH, -NH2, -NHZi, and -NZ╬╣Z , wherein m is 0, 1 or 2 , and Z┬▒ and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 ' carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -OC[(Z3) (Z4)]qO-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms,
(c) R2 is selected from the group, consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms/ and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms, (d) R3 is selected from the group consisting of
Figure imgf000101_0001
, and where d is a integer from 0 to 5 and W is -N- or -CH-;
'(e) R. is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORI, - HR-L, -StO^R^ wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, and Rλ is a defined above, with the proviso that Rχ is
ΓÇöN v not a camphor derivative or vΓÇö heterocycle, (ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3,or -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR8, -CH3 , halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)ORs and -S(0)pR8/ wherein Rs is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and p is 0, 1 or 2,
(v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms, (vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms,
(viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(xi) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(f) R5 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN v derivative or ^ΓÇö s heterocycle, (ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -0CF3,or OCF2H, and
(iii)halogen;
(g) ' R6 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, or -S(0)nRl. wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN v derivative or ^ΓÇö' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3,or -OCF2H, (iii)halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z6, wherein Z6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg, -C(0)OH, -C(0)ORg, and -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yl, Y2 and/or Y3. or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, (v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(viii) heteroaralkyl .of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder ΓÇó of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and (x) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; and
(h) R7 is selected from the group consisting of (i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above with the
ΓÇö v proviso that Ri is not an camphor derivative or ^-^ heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3 or CF2H,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O -CO2R1O -SO2R1O or -CONRioRll, wherein each of RIQ and Rn is independnetly selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O -CO2RIO/
-S╬╕2Rl0/╬╕r -CONRioRll,
(v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll, (vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10. -C╬╕2Rl╬╕> -SO2R1O or
-CONRioRll, and
(vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ -CO2R1O -S╬╕2RlO ╬╕r -CONRioRll, or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
2. A compound according to claim 1, wherein X is selected from the group consisting of a direct link, -SO2-, and -NH-S(0)2-.
3. A compound according to claim 2 , wherein X is -SO2-.
4. A compound according to claim 1, wherein Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aralkyl, and aryl.
5. A compound according to claim 4, wherein Ri is aralkyl selected from substituted benzyl and unsubstituted benzyl, or is. aryl selected from substituted phenyl, unsubstituted phenyl, substituted naphthyl and unsubstituted naphthyl.
6. A compound according to claim 5, wherein R-j_ is aryl substituted with a group selected from the group consisting of methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, and -OCF3.
7. A compound according to claim 5, wherein Ri is cyclohexyl or cyclohexylmethyl.
8. A compound according to claim 4, wherein Ri is aralkyl.
9. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R2 is hydrogen.
10. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R3 is
Figure imgf000105_0001
11. A compound accor Xding)to c.laim 1, wherein R4 is selected from the group consisting of: (a) hydrogen, (b) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR8/ -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)0R╬▓, -S(0)30H and
Figure imgf000106_0001
(c) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cyclic alkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(d) alkenyl,
(e) cycloalkyl,
(f) heteroaryl, (g) heteroaralkyl, and (h) trifluoromethyl.
12. A compound according to claim 11, wherein R4 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, (R) -sec-butyl, (S) -sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, (R) -2-pentyl, (S)-2- pentyl, 3-pentyl, (S) -1- (2-methyl) -butyl, (R) -2- (3-methyl) - butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, (R)-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-hexyl, (S)-2-hexyl, (R)-2-hexyl, (R)-3-hexyl, (S)-3-hexyl, hydroxy, -OR8, wherein R8 is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, phenyloxy, -OCF3. and halogen.
13. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl of 1 to about 5 carbon atoms, trifluoromethyl, alkoxy of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms.
14. A compound according to claim 13 , wherein R5 is hydrogen.
15. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R╬▓ is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen, (b) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z6, (c) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl,
(d) alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, (e) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yl, Y2 and/or Y3,
(f) heteroaralkyl ring of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrog'en, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, (g) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and,
(h) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
16. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R4 and R5 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and methyl and Re is selected from the group consisting of aralkyl of about 8 to about 13 carbon atoms, -O-aralkyl, -NH-aralkyl, and -S(0)p-aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms.
17. A compound according to claim 16, wherein said aralkyl group has an aryl group selected from unsubstituted phenyl, substituted phenyl, substituted naphthyl and unsubstituted naphthyl.
18. A compound according to claim 17, wherein said aryl group is substituted with a substituent selected from the group consisting of methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro and trifluoromethyl .
19. A compound according to claim 15, wherein R╬▓ is selected from the group consisting of phenylethyl, phenylpropyl , cyclohexylethyl and cyclohexylpropyl.
20. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, difluorome hyl and trifluoromethyl.
21. A compound according to claim 20, wherein R7 is hydrogen or methyl .
22. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R7 is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2 IO/ -S╬╕2RlO/╬╕r -CONRioRll, (b) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2 1O or -CONRioRll,
(c) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O/ -S╬╕2 lO/╬╕r -CONRioRll,
(d) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O/ -SO2R1O/ or
-CONRioRll, and (e) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms , optionally substituted with -CH2OR10,
-CO2R1O/ -SO2R1O and -CONRioRll-
23. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R5 and Rg are independently selected from hydrogen and methyl, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, (R) -sec-butyl, (S) -sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, (R) -2-pentyl, (S) -2-pentyl, 3-pentyl, (S)-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, (R) -2- (3-methyl) -butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl,
(R)-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-hexyl, (S)-2-hexyl,
(R)-2-hexyl, (R)-3-hexyl, and
(S)-3-hexyl.
24. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R4, R5, and R╬▓ , are independently selected from hydrogen and methyl.
25. A compound according to claim 1, wherein any two of R2 , R4, R5 , and Rg are hydrogen.
26. A compound according to claim 1, wherein X is -S(0)2-/ Rl is substituted or unsubstituted aralkyl, and R3 is
Figure imgf000109_0001
27. A compound accor Xding)to claim 26, wherein Ri is substituted or unsubstituted benzyl.
28 . A compound of the formula :
Figure imgf000110_0001
wherein, (a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S(0)2-,
-N(R')-S(0)2-, -(C=0)-, -OC(=0)-, -NH-C(=0)-, -P (0) (R" ) - and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is -NR', -OR' , -R' , or -SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
(1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted in the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or CO2R' ,
(3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted in the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02R',
(4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02 ' /
(5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or
C02R' /
(6) alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02R',
(7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3 ,
(8) heteroaryl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(9) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, respectively,
(11) aralkenyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3 , respectively, (12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2/ and/or Y3, respectively,
Figure imgf000112_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,
(19) perfluoroaryl alkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and
(21)
Figure imgf000112_0002
is a 5 to 7 member heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is -CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2- or -S-, wherein Yi, Y2, and Y3 are (i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, CH(CF3)2, -C(OH) (CF3) 2, -OCF3, -OCF2CF3, -OC(0)NH2, -OC(0)NHZl, -OC(0)NZlZ2, -NHC(0)Zl, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NZl, -NHC (0)NZlZ2 , -C(0)OH, -C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZl, -C(0)NZlZ2, -CfOJOZ-L, -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)OH, -P(0)3(Zl)2/ -S(0)3H , -S(0)mZ1/ -Z , -OZχ, -OH, -NH2, -NHZi, and -NZιZ2, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, and Z-^ and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be
-0C[(Z3) (Z4)]gO-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms;
(c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms;
(d) R4 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl┬╗ wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, and Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is
ΓÇöN v not a camphor derivative or >ΓÇö' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3. -0CF2H, (iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR╬▓, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)0H, -C(0)OR╬▓ and -S(0)pR8, wherein Rs is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and p is 0, 1 or 2,
(v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cyclic alkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms, (vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms ,
(viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(ix) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(e) 5 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇö v derivative or -ΓÇö heterocycle, (ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3 , -OCF2H, and
( iii) halogen;
(f) 6 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN v derivative or ^ΓÇö' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z6, wherein Z6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg,
-C(0)OH, -C(0)0R9, and -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, (v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, or heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(viii) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl with Yl, Y2 and/or Y3, and (x) heteroaralkenyl ring of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms with 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3; (g) R7 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above, with the N V proviso that R7 is not an Ri camphor derivative or ^ " heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3 or CF2H,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll, wherein each of Ri and R^ is independently selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, CO2R1O -S╬╕2Rl╬╕┬╗ CONRioRll,
(v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll, (vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms, having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ CO2R1O' -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll, and
(vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 16 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, which is optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, CO2R1O SO2R1O CONRioRll; emd (h) R12 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with amino, amidino or guanidino,
(ii) aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is. optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino,
(iii) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino,
(iv) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino; and
(j) TS is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -CHO,
(ii) -C(0)CF3,
(iii) -C(0)CF2CF3,
(iv) -C(0)-C(0)-NHR13,
(v) -C(0)-C(0)2R13,
(vi) -C(0)-C(0)-NR13R14,
(vii) -B(OR13) (0R14),
(viii) -C(0)CH2C1, and
(ix) -C(0)-R15;
wherein R-^ a^d R]_4 are independently selected from hydrogen lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur; or when TS is -B(OR13) (OR1 ) then OR13 and OR14 may be taken together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z )]qO-; and R15 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms and heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
29. A compound of the formula:
Figure imgf000118_0001
wherein
(a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S(0)2-,
-N(R')-S(0)2-, -C(=0)-, -OC(=0)-, -NH-C(=0)-, -P (0) (R" ) - and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is -NHR',
-OR' , -R' , or -SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
(1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
(3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -CO2R' ,
(4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02R'# (5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or
-C02R',
(6) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or -C02 ' ,
(7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, (8) heteroaryl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, (9) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, (11) aralkenyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring atoms which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or
Y3,
(12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
Figure imgf000120_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,
(19) perfluoroaralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and ΓÇöN v ΓÇöN V
(21) wherein ""ΓÇö-' is a 5 to 7 membered heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is
-CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2- or -S-, and wherein Yi, Y2 , and Y3 are
(i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl , amino, guanidino, amidino , methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, -CH(CF3)2, -C (OH) (CF3) 2, -OCF3 , -OCF2CF3, -OC(0)NH2, -OC(0)NHZl, -OC(0)NZlZ2, -NHC(0)Zι, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NHZl, -NHC(0)NZlZ2, -C(0)OH, -C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZl, -C(0)NZlZ2, -CtOJOZi, -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)0H, -P(0)3(Zl)2/ -S(0)3H , -S(0)mZ1/ -Zχ, -OZ1# -OH, -NH2, -NHZi, and -NZιZ2 wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, and Z-j_ and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -OC[(Z3) (Z4)]qO-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms,
(c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms,
(d) R3 is
Figure imgf000121_0001
, where d is an integer from 0 to 5;
(e) R4 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl# wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, and Ri is a defined above, with the proviso that Ri is ΓÇöN V not a camphor derivative or vΓÇö- heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3,or -OCF2H,
(iii) halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -0R8, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)0H, -C(0)ORs and -S(0)pR8, wherein R8 is alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and p is 0, 1 or 2,
(v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms,
(viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(xi) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(f) R5 s selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl┬╗ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN V derivative or ^ΓÇö/ heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -0CF3,or OCF2H, and
(iii) alogen;
(g) R6 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, or -S(0)nRl/ wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN v derivative or ^S heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -0CF3,or -OCF2H,
(iii)halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Zg, wherein Z6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg, -C(0)OH, -C(0)0Rg, and -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring w$th Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, or heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(viii) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yχf Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and
(x) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3 ; and (h) R7 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above with the
ΓÇöN v proviso that Ri is not an camphor derivative or v*ΓÇö z heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3 or CF2H, (iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O -CO2R1O/ -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll/ wherein each of Rχo an<^ Rll i independnetly selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen, (iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ -CO2R1O/
-S02RlO/┬░r -CONRioRll,
(v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ -CO2 1O' -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll,
(vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O -SO2R1O or
-CONRioRll, an (vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2RIO -S╬╕2RlO ╬╕r -CONRioRll, or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof;
30. A compound according to claim 29,herein X is selected from the group consisting of a direct link, -S02- and -NH-S(0)2-.
31. A compound according to claim 30, wherein X is -S02- .
32. A compound according to claim 29,wherein Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aralkyl, and aryl.
33. A compound according to claim 32 'wherein Ri is aralkyl selected from substituted benzyl and unsubstituted benzyl, or is aryl selected from substituted phenyl, unsubstituted phenyl, substituted naphthyl and unsubstituted naphthyl .
34. A compound according to claim 33 , wherein R1 is aryl substituted with a group selected from the group consisting of methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, and -OCF3.
35. A compound according to claim 33, wherein Ri is cyclohexyl or cyclohexylmethyl.
36. A compound according to claim 32' wherein Ri is aralkyl .
37. A compound according to claim 29, wherein R2 is hydrogen.
38. A compound according to claim 29 /wherein R4 is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen, (b) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR8, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)OR8/ -S(0)3╬╕H and -S(0)pR8,
(c) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cyclic alkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(d) alkenyl, (e) cycloalkyl ,
(f) heteroaryl ,
(g) heteroaralkyl , and
(h) trifluoromethyl .
39. A compound according to claim 38, wherein R4 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, (R) -sec-butyl, (S)-sec-butyi, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, (R) -2-pentyl, (S)-2- pentyl, 3-pentyl, (S) -1- (2-methyl) -butyl, (R) -2- (3-methyl) - butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, (R) -1- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-hexyl, (S)-2-hexyl, (R)-2-hexyl, (R)-3-hexyl, (S)-3-hexyl, hydroxy, -ORs, wherein R8 is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, phenyloxy, -OCF3. and halogen.
40. A compound according to claim 29, herein R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl of 1 to about 5 carbon atoms, trifluoromethyl, alkoxy of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms .
41. A compound according to claim 40 , wherein R5 is hydrogen.
42. A compound according to claim 29 , wherein R╬▓ is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) hydrogen,
(b) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z6, (c) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl,
(d) alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl,
(e) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yl , Y2 and/ or Y3 ,
(f) heteroaralkyl ring of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(g) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3, and,
(h) heteroaralkenyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3.
43. A compound according to claim 29 , wherein R4 and R5 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and methyl and R╬▓ is selected from the group consisting of aralkyl of about 8 to about 13 carbon atoms, -O-aralkyl, -NH-aralkyl, and -S(0)p-aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms .
44. A compound according to claim 43 , wherein said aralkyl group has an aryl group selected from unsubstituted phenyl, substituted phenyl, substituted naphthyl and unsubstituted naphthyl.
45. A compound according to claim 44, wherein said aryl group is substituted with a substituent selected from the group consisting of methyl, methoxy, fluoro, chloro and trifluoromethyl .
46. A compound according to claim 42 , wherein R6 is selected from the group consisting of phenylethyl, phenylpropyl , cyclohexylethyl and cyclohexylpropyl .
47. A compound according to claim 29 /wherein R7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl.
48. A compound according to claim 47 , wherein R7 is hydrogen or methyl .
49. A compound according to claim 29, wherein R7 is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2 1O/ -S╬╕2RlO ╬╕r -CONRioRll,
(b) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll,
(c) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O -CO2RIO/ -S╬╕2RlO/╬╕r
-CONRioRll,
(d) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R10/ -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll, nd
(e) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, -CO2R1O/ -SO2R10. and -CONRioRll-
50. A compound according to claim 29, herein R5 and R6 are independently selected from hydrogen and methyl, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propenyl, allyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, (R) -sec-butyl, (S) -sec-butyl, isobutyl, 1-pentyl, (R) -2-pentyl, (S) -2-pentyl, 3-pentyl, (S)-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, (R) -2- (3-methyl) -butyl, 1- (3-methyl) -butyl, (R)-l- (2-methyl) -butyl, cyclopentyl, 1-hexyl, (S)-2-hexyl, (R)-2-hexyl, (R)-3-hexyl, and (S)-3-hexyl.
51. A compound according to claim 29,wherein R4, R5 , and R6/ are independently selected from hydrogen and methyl.
52. A compound according to claim 29, wherein any two of R2, R4, R5, and Rg are hydrogen.
553. A compound according to claim 29 wherein d is 2.
54. A compound according to claim 53, wherein X is -S(0)2-/ and Ri is substituted or unsubstituted aralkyl.
55. A compound according to claim 54, wherein Ri is substituted or unsubstituted benzyl.
55. A compound of the formula:
Figure imgf000129_0001
wherein,
(a) X is selected from the group consisting of -S(0) -,
-N(R')-S(0)2-, -(C=0)-, -OC(=0)-, -NH-C(=0)-, -P(O) (R") - and a direct link, wherein R' is hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or aralkyl of about 6 to about 16 carbon atoms, and R" is -NR' , -OR' , -R«, or -SR' ;
(b) Ri is selected from the group consisting of: (1) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(2) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with cycloalkyl of about 5 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted in the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02R' ,
(3) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 15 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted in the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to. C3 alkoxy, or C02R' ,
(4) heterocycloalkyl of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, wherein i is 0, 1 or 2, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02R'
(5) heterocyclo of 4 to about 10 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from the group consisting of oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally substituted on the ring carbons with hydroxyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Cl to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or
C02R', (6) alkenyl of about 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, which optionally is substituted on the ring carbons with hydrosqrl, amino, guanidino, amidino, Ci to C3 alkyl, Ci to C3 alkoxy, or C02 ' , (7) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(8) heteroaryl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3,
(9) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3 ,
(10) heteroaralkyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3 , respectively,
(11) aralkenyl of about 8 to about 16 carbon atoms having 6 to about 14 ring carbons which is optionally mono-, di-, or tri-substituted on the aryl ring with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3 , respectively,
(12) heteroaralkenyl of 5 to 14 ring atoms with the ring atoms selected from carbon and heteroatoms, wherein the heteroatoms are selected from oxygen, nitrogen, and S(0)i, and which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring carbons with Yi, Y2, and/or Y3, respectively,
Figure imgf000131_0001
Figure imgf000132_0001
(17) perfluoroalkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms,
(18) perfluoroaryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms,,
(19) perfluoroaryl alkyl of about 7 to about 15 ' carbon atoms,
(20) hydrogen, and N V ΓÇöN V (21) *^-Z . wherein "^^ is a 5 to 7 member heterocyclic ring having 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, where V is -CH2-, -0-, -S(=0)-, -S(0)2" o -S-, wherein Yi, Y2, and Y3 are
(i) independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, tetrazolyl, amino, guanidino, amidino, methylamino, methylguanidino, -CF3, -CF2CF3, -CF2H, CH(CF3)2/ -C (OH) (CF3) 2, -OCF3 , -OCF2CF3, -OC(0)NH2, -OC(0)NHZi, -0C(0)NZlZ2, -NHC(0)Zι, -NHC(0)NH2, -NHC(0)NZi, -NHC (0)NZlZ2, -C(0)0H, -C(0)NH2, -C(0)NHZl, -C(0)NZiZ2, -C(0)OZ1, -P(0)3H, -P(0)3H2, -PH(0)OH, -P(0)3(Zi)2, -S(0)3H , -S(0)mZlf -Zχ , -0Z±, -OH, -NH2, -NHZl, and -NZ1Z2, wherein m is 0, 1 or 2, and Z± and Z2 are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms, or
(ii) Yi and Y2 are selected together to be -OC[(Z3) (Z4)]qO-, wherein q is an integer from 1 to 4 and Z3 and Z4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms heteroaryl of about 5 to about 14 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 6 to about 11 atoms having about 3 to about 9 carbon atoms; (c) R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms, and alkenyl of about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms;
(d) R4 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl/ wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, and Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that .R ' is
ΓÇöN v not a camphor derivative or ^-^ heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, -OCF2H,
(iii)halogen,
(iv) alkyl of 1 to 6 carbon atoms substituted with Z5, wherein Z5 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -OH, -OR8, -CH3, halogen, -C(0)OH, -C(0)ORs and -S(0)pR8, wherein R8 is alkyl of 1 to. about 6 carbon atoms, and p is 0, 1 or 2,
(v) alkyl of 1 to 3 carbon atoms substituted with cyclic alkyl of 3 to 5 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of about 3 to about 6 carbon atoms,
(vii) cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms ,
(viii) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and
(ix) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
(e) 5 s selected from the group consisting of
(i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nRl, wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that i is not a camphor ΓÇöN V derivative or ^ ' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, -OCF2H, and
(iii) halogen; (f) R6 is selected from the group consisting of (i) -Ri, -ORi, -NHRi, -S(0)nR╬╣, wherein Ri is as defined above, with the proviso that Ri is not a camphor
ΓÇöN v derivative or v*ΓÇö heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3, -CF2H, -OCF3, -OCF2H, (iii) halogen, (iv) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms substituted with Z╬▓ , wherein Z6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxy, halogen, -ORg, -NHRg, -C(0)OH, -C(0)ORg, and -S(0)pRg, wherein Rg is alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of about 7 to about 12 carbon atoms, heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3 , and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted in the ring carbons with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(v) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted- with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms,
(vi) alkenyl of 2 to about 6 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with cycloalkyl of about 3 to about 8 carbon atoms, aryl of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms, or heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms,
(vii) aralkyl of about 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(viii) heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally substituted on the alkyl chain with hydroxy or halogen, and optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the ring with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3,
(ix) aralkenyl of about 6 to 15 carbon atoms which is optionally mono-, di- or tri-substituted on the aryl with Yl, Y2 and/or Y3, and
(x) heteroaralkenyl ring of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms with 1 to 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, which is optionally mono-, di- or tri- substituted with Yi, Y2 and/or Y3;
(g) R7 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) Ri, wherein Ri is as defined above, with the
ΓÇöN v proviso that R7 is not an Ri camphor derivative or ┬╗ΓÇö ' heterocycle,
(ii) -CF3 or CF2H,
(iii) alkyl of 1 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ -CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ -CONRioRll, wherein each of Ri and R11 is independently selected and is alkyl of 1 to about 4 carbon atoms or hydrogen,
(iv) alkenyl of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ CONRioRll, (v) cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O -CO2R1O/ -SO2 1O -CONRioRll,
(vi) heteroaryl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms, having about 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with -CH2OR1O/ CO2R1O -SO2R1O/ or -CONRioRll, and
(vii) alkyl of 1 to about 3 carbon atoms substituted with heteroaryl of about 5 to about 16 atoms having 1 to about 9 carbon atoms, which is optionally substituted with -CH2OR10, CO2R1O/ SO2RIO/ CONRioRll; and (h) R12 is selected from the group consisting of
(i) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted with amino, amidino or guanidino,
(ii) aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino,
(iii) aryl of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino, or guanidino, (iv) heteroaralkyl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur which is optionally substituted on a ring carbon with amino, amidino or guanidino; and (j) TS is selected from the group consisting of (i) -CHO,
(ii) -C(0)CF3,
(iii) -C(0)CF2CF3,
(iv) -C (0) -C (0) -imR.3 , (v) -C(O) -CtO).^,
(vi) -CtOJ-CtO-NR^,
Figure imgf000136_0001
(viii) -C(Q)CH-C1, and
(ix) -CfOJ-R^; wherein R13 and Rli are independently selected from hydrogen, lower alkyl of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, cycloalkyl of 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, aralkyl of 7 to about 15 carbon atoms, and heteroaralkyl of about 5 to about 10 ring atoms having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms which include 1 to about 9 ring carbon atoms and he remainder of the ring atoms heteroatoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur; or when TS is -BfOR^) (OR14) then OR13 and OR^ may be taken together to be -0[C(Z3) (Z4)]qO-; and R15 is selected from aryl of 6 to about 14 carbon atoms or heteroaryl of 5 to about 14 ring atoms having 1 to about 13 ring carbon atoms and the remainder of the ring atoms selected from oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
PCT/US1998/025167 1997-11-26 1998-11-23 Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii) WO1999026920A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
AU16056/99A AU1605699A (en) 1997-11-26 1998-11-23 Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii)

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US08/979,440 1997-11-26
US08/979,440 US6204384B1 (en) 1997-11-26 1997-11-26 Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (II)
US08/980,114 US6011047A (en) 1997-11-26 1997-11-26 Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US08/980,114 1997-11-26

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO1999026920A1 true WO1999026920A1 (en) 1999-06-03

Family

ID=27130603

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US1998/025167 WO1999026920A1 (en) 1997-11-26 1998-11-23 Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii)

Country Status (2)

Country Link
AU (1) AU1605699A (en)
WO (1) WO1999026920A1 (en)

Cited By (16)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2002042272A2 (en) * 2000-11-20 2002-05-30 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridines useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6458952B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2002-10-01 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6653316B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2003-11-25 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrimidinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6660885B2 (en) 2000-03-13 2003-12-09 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted benzenes useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6664255B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2003-12-16 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6686484B2 (en) 2000-04-17 2004-02-03 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 1,4-quinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6693121B2 (en) 2000-04-05 2004-02-17 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 4-pyridones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6716838B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2004-04-06 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils as anticoagulative agents
US6750342B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2004-06-15 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrimidinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6867217B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2005-03-15 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6875791B2 (en) 2000-04-05 2005-04-05 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 4-pyrones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6969715B2 (en) 2001-10-03 2005-11-29 Pharmacia Corporation 6-membered heterocyclic compounds useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7015223B1 (en) 2000-11-20 2006-03-21 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl 1,2,4-triazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7015230B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2006-03-21 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7105559B2 (en) 2001-10-03 2006-09-12 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted 5-membered polycyclic compounds useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7119094B1 (en) 2000-11-20 2006-10-10 Warner-Lambert Company Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroarpyl pyrazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade

Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
FR2490632A1 (en) * 1980-09-19 1982-03-26 Nippon Kayaku Kk L-ARGININAL DERIVATIVES AND PREPARATION METHOD
EP0526877A2 (en) * 1991-08-06 1993-02-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Peptide aldehydes as antithrombotic agents
EP0672659A1 (en) * 1994-03-04 1995-09-20 Eli Lilly And Company Antithrombotic agents
WO1995035312A1 (en) * 1994-06-17 1995-12-28 Corvas International, Inc. Arginine mimic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1995035313A1 (en) * 1994-06-17 1995-12-28 Corvas International, Inc. 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives containing an arginine mimic as enzyme inhibitors
WO1996018644A1 (en) * 1994-12-13 1996-06-20 Corvas International, Inc. Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors

Patent Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
FR2490632A1 (en) * 1980-09-19 1982-03-26 Nippon Kayaku Kk L-ARGININAL DERIVATIVES AND PREPARATION METHOD
EP0526877A2 (en) * 1991-08-06 1993-02-10 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Peptide aldehydes as antithrombotic agents
EP0672659A1 (en) * 1994-03-04 1995-09-20 Eli Lilly And Company Antithrombotic agents
WO1995035312A1 (en) * 1994-06-17 1995-12-28 Corvas International, Inc. Arginine mimic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1995035313A1 (en) * 1994-06-17 1995-12-28 Corvas International, Inc. 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives containing an arginine mimic as enzyme inhibitors
WO1996018644A1 (en) * 1994-12-13 1996-06-20 Corvas International, Inc. Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors

Cited By (22)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6716838B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2004-04-06 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils as anticoagulative agents
US6458952B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2002-10-01 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7015230B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2006-03-21 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl uracils useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6870056B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2005-03-22 Pharmacia Corporation Substitituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6653316B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2003-11-25 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrimidinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6867217B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2005-03-15 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6664255B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2003-12-16 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6750342B1 (en) 1999-05-19 2004-06-15 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyrimidinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6660885B2 (en) 2000-03-13 2003-12-09 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted benzenes useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6852761B2 (en) 2000-03-13 2005-02-08 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted benzenes useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6875791B2 (en) 2000-04-05 2005-04-05 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 4-pyrones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6693121B2 (en) 2000-04-05 2004-02-17 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 4-pyridones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6916847B2 (en) 2000-04-05 2005-07-12 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 4-pyrones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6686484B2 (en) 2000-04-17 2004-02-03 Pharmacia Corporation Polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl substituted 1,4-quinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6828338B2 (en) 2000-11-20 2004-12-07 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridines useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
WO2002042272A2 (en) * 2000-11-20 2002-05-30 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridines useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6624180B2 (en) 2000-11-20 2003-09-23 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridines useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7015223B1 (en) 2000-11-20 2006-03-21 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl 1,2,4-triazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
WO2002042272A3 (en) * 2000-11-20 2003-07-24 Pharmacia Corp Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroaryl pyridines useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7119094B1 (en) 2000-11-20 2006-10-10 Warner-Lambert Company Substituted polycyclic aryl and heteroarpyl pyrazinones useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US6969715B2 (en) 2001-10-03 2005-11-29 Pharmacia Corporation 6-membered heterocyclic compounds useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade
US7105559B2 (en) 2001-10-03 2006-09-12 Pharmacia Corporation Substituted 5-membered polycyclic compounds useful for selective inhibition of the coagulation cascade

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU1605699A (en) 1999-06-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US5932733A (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives containing an arginine mimic as enzyme inhibitors
US5656645A (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
EP0804464B1 (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US5637599A (en) Arginine mimic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US5658930A (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US6034215A (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidnercetic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US6011158A (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1995035311A9 (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1996018644A9 (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1995035311A1 (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
EP0765340B1 (en) Methionine sulfone and s-substituted cysteine sulfone derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO1999026920A1 (en) Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (ii)
US5714499A (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives containing an arginine mimic as enzyme inhibitors
US6342504B1 (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US5955576A (en) Inhibitors of thrombosis
US6011047A (en) Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US6506754B1 (en) Non-covalent thrombin inhibitors
WO2001079261A1 (en) Tetrahydro-azepinone derivatives as thrombin inhibitors
US6777431B2 (en) Non-convalent thrombin inhibitors
US6204384B1 (en) Substituted 3-amino-2-hydroxyphenylacetamide derivatives as enzyme inhibitors (II)
US6541467B1 (en) Thrombin inhibitors having a lactam at P3
EP0765338B1 (en) Arginine mimic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
US6608204B1 (en) Aromatic heterocyclic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
AU700808B2 (en) 3-amino-2-oxo-1-piperidineacetic derivatives as enzyme inhibitors
WO2001027141A1 (en) Inhibitors of factor xa having an arginine or arginine aldehyde mimic

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BY CA CH CN CU CZ DE DK EE ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MD MG MK MN MW MX NO NZ PL PT RO RU SD SE SG SI SK SL TJ TM TR TT UA UG US UZ VN YU ZW

AL Designated countries for regional patents

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): GH GM KE LS MW SD SZ UG ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE CH CY DE DK ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LU MC NL PT SE BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
DFPE Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed before 20040101)
NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: KR

REG Reference to national code

Ref country code: DE

Ref legal event code: 8642

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase
NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: CA